blob: 8938195a2cc5019d75d2c8ef68f2c65f926da34e [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue54b43a2019-11-25 19:47:40 +01007 2019/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100676. Cache
686.1. Limitation
696.2. Setup
706.2.1. Cache section
716.2.2. Proxy section
72
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200737. Using ACLs and fetching samples
747.1. ACL basics
757.1.1. Matching booleans
767.1.2. Matching integers
777.1.3. Matching strings
787.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
797.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
807.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
817.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
827.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200837.3.1. Converters
847.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
857.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
867.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
877.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
887.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200897.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090
918. Logging
928.1. Log levels
938.2. Log formats
948.2.1. Default log format
958.2.2. TCP log format
968.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100978.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100988.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200998.3. Advanced logging options
1008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1018.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1028.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1038.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1048.4. Timing events
1058.5. Session state at disconnection
1068.6. Non-printable characters
1078.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1088.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1098.9. Examples of logs
110
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001119. Supported filters
1129.1. Trace
1139.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001159.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001169.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200117
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011810. FastCGI applications
11910.1. Setup
12010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12110.1.2. Proxy section
12210.1.3. Example
12310.2. Default parameters
12410.3. Limitations
125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126
1271. Quick reminder about HTTP
128----------------------------
129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100130When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
132on almost anything found in the contents.
133
134However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
135formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
136correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
137
138
1391.1. The HTTP transaction model
140-------------------------------
141
142The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100143to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100144from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
145connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146will involve a new connection :
147
148 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
149
150In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
151establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
152by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
153length.
154
155Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
156to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
157however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
158response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
159header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
160
161 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
162
163Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
164power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
165but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200166a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100168Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
170second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
171page :
172
173 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
174
175This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
176latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
177correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
178the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100179server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
182time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
183are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
184parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
185carry the stream identifier.
186
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
188connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
189leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
191processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
192waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200193
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200194HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100195 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
196 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100197 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200199 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100201For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
202the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100203server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
204is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
205servers.
206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207
2081.2. HTTP request
209-----------------
210
211First, let's consider this HTTP request :
212
213 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
216 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
217 3 User-agent: my small browser
218 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
219 5 Accept: image/png
220
221
2221.2.1. The Request line
223-----------------------
224
225Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
226
227 - a METHOD : GET
228 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
229 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
230
231All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
232which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
233followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
234is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
235desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
236the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
237
238The URI itself can have several forms :
239
240 - A "relative URI" :
241
242 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
243
244 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
245 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
246
247 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
248
249 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
250
251 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
252 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
253 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
254 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
255 must accept this form too.
256
257 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
258 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
259 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200261 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
262 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
263 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
264 other protocols too.
265
266In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
267mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
268on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
269It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
270specific to the language, framework or application in use.
271
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100273assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
275received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
276processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
277as well as in server logs.
278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
295as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296
297The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
298that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
299is one valid form of empty line.
300
301Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
302headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
303about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
304application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
305
306Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000307 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
309 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
310 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
311
312
3131.3. HTTP response
314------------------
315
316An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
317messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
318
319 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100320 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200321 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
322 2 Content-length: 350
323 3 Content-Type: text/html
324
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200325As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
326codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
327response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100328continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
329the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
330following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
331sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
332(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
333correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
334such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
335state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
336over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
337if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
338information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003411.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342------------------------
343
344Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
345
346 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
347 - a status code : 200
348 - a reason : OK
349
350The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100351 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
352 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
353 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
354 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
355 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000357Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100358"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
360messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
361or "Authentication Required".
362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364
365 Code When / reason
366 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
367 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
369 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100370 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200372 400 for an invalid or too large request
373 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
374 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200375 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
479
480 Example:
481
482 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
483
484 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
485
486 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
487
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200488Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
489file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
492 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
493
494* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
495 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
496 directory.
497
498* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
499
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500500* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200501 processes, separated by semicolons.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 CLI, separated by semicolons.
505
506See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200507
5082.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200509----------------
510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100511Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100512values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
513otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
514numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
515for every keyword. Supported units are :
516
517 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
518 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
519 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
520 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
521 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
522 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
523
524
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005252.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200526-------------
527
528 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
529 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
530 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
531 global
532 daemon
533 maxconn 256
534
535 defaults
536 mode http
537 timeout connect 5000ms
538 timeout client 50000ms
539 timeout server 50000ms
540
541 frontend http-in
542 bind *:80
543 default_backend servers
544
545 backend servers
546 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
547
548
549 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
550 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
551 global
552 daemon
553 maxconn 256
554
555 defaults
556 mode http
557 timeout connect 5000ms
558 timeout client 50000ms
559 timeout server 50000ms
560
561 listen http-in
562 bind *:80
563 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
564
565
566Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
567
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100568 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200569
570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005713. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572--------------------
573
574Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
575are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
576of them have command-line equivalents.
577
578The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
579
580 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200581 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200582 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200583 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - description
587 - deviceatlas-json-file
588 - deviceatlas-log-level
589 - deviceatlas-separator
590 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900591 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - gid
593 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100594 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200595 - h1-case-adjust
596 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100597 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200599 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100600 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200601 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200602 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200603 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200604 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100607 - presetenv
608 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609 - uid
610 - ulimit-n
611 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200612 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100613 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200614 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200616 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200617 - ssl-default-bind-options
618 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200619 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200620 - ssl-default-server-options
621 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100622 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100623 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100624 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100625 - 51degrees-data-file
626 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200627 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200628 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200629 - wurfl-data-file
630 - wurfl-information-list
631 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200632 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100633 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100634
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100636 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200637 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200638 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200639 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100640 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100641 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100642 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200643 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200644 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200645 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200646 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647 - noepoll
648 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000649 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200650 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100651 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300652 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000653 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100654 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200655 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200656 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200657 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000658 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000659 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200660 - tune.buffers.limit
661 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200662 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200663 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100664 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200665 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200666 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200667 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100668 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200669 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200670 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100671 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100672 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100673 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100674 - tune.lua.session-timeout
675 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200676 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100677 - tune.maxaccept
678 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200679 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200680 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200681 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100682 - tune.rcvbuf.client
683 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100684 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200685 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100686 - tune.sndbuf.client
687 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100688 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100689 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200690 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100691 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200692 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200693 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100694 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200695 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100696 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200697 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
698 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
699 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100700 - tune.zlib.memlevel
701 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703 * Debugging
704 - debug
705 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706
707
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007083.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200709------------------------------------
710
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200711ca-base <dir>
712 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200713 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
714 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200716chroot <jail dir>
717 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
718 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
719 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
720 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
721 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100722 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100723
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100724cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
725 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
726 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
727 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
728 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
729 set. These sets have the format
730
731 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
732
733 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100734 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100735 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
736 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100737 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
738 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100739 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100740 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100742 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100743 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
744 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
745 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
746 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100747
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100748 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
749 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
750 on the machine's word size.
751
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100753 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
754 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
755 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
756 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
757 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
758 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759
760 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100761 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
762
763 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
764 # first 4 CPUs
765
766 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
767 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
768 # word size.
769
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100770 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100771 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
773 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
774 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
775
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100776 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
777 # and so on.
778 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
779 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
780 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
781
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100783 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
784 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
785 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
786
787 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
788 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
789 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
790
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100791 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
792 # and a thread range.
793 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
794 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
795 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
796
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200797crt-base <dir>
798 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
799 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
800 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
801
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200802daemon
803 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
804 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100805 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
806 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200807
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200808deviceatlas-json-file <path>
809 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100810 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200811
812deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100813 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200814 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
815
816deviceatlas-separator <char>
817 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
818 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
819
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100820deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200821 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
822 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
823 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100824
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900825external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100826 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
827 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
828 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well.
829 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900830
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200831gid <number>
832 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
833 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
834 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100835 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
836 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200837 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100838
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100839group <group name>
840 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
841 See also "gid" and "user".
842
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100843hard-stop-after <time>
844 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
845
846 Arguments :
847 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
848 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
849 SIGUSR1 signal.
850
851 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
852 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
853 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
854
855 Example:
856 global
857 hard-stop-after 30s
858
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200859h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
860 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
861 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
862 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
863 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
864 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
865 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
866 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
867 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
868 specified in a proxy.
869
870 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
871 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
872 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
873 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
874 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
875 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
876 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
877
878 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
879 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
880 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
881 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
882 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
883
884 Example:
885 global
886 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
887
888 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
889 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
890
891h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
892 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
893 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
894 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
895 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
896 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
897 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
898 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
899 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
900
901 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
902 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
903 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
904
905 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
906 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
907
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100908insecure-fork-wanted
909 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
910 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
911 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
912 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
913 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
914 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
915 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
916 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
917 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
918 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
919 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
920 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
921 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
922 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
923 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
924 disable it.
925
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200926log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
927 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100928 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100929 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100930 configured with "log global".
931
932 <address> can be one of:
933
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100934 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100935 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
936 port).
937
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100938 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
939 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
940 port).
941
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100942 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100943 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
944 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100945 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100946
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100947 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
948 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
949 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
950 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
951 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
952 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
953 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
954 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
955 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
956 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
957 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
958 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
959 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
960 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100961 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
962 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100963
964 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
965 "fd@2", see above.
966
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200967 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
968 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
969 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
970 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
971 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
972
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200973 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
974 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100975
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200976 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
977 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
978 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
979 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
980 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
981 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
982 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
983 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
984 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
985 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100986 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
987 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200988
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200989 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
990 one of the following :
991
992 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
993 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
994
995 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
996 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
997
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100998 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
999 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1000 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1001 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1002 logger consumes.
1003
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001004 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1005 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1006 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1007 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1008
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001009 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1010 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1011 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1012 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1013 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1014
1015 <sample_size>
1016 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1017 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1018 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1019 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1020 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1021
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001022 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001023
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001024 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1025 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1026 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1027
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001028 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1029 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1030 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1031 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032
1033 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001034 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1035 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1036 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1037 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1038 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1039 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001041 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001042
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001043log-send-hostname [<string>]
1044 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1045 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1046 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1047 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1048 the logs.
1049
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001050log-tag <string>
1051 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1052 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1053 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001054 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001055
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001056lua-load <file>
1057 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1058 used multiple times.
1059
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001060master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001061 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1062 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1063 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001064 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001065 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1066 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001067 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1068 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1069 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1070 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1071 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001072
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001073 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001074
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001075mworker-max-reloads <number>
1076 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001077 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001078 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1079 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1080 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1081
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082nbproc <number>
1083 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1084 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1085 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001086 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1087 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001088 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1089 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001091nbthread <number>
1092 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001093 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1094 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1095 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1096 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1097 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001098 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1099 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1100 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1101 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1102 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1103 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1104 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001105
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001106pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001107 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001108 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1109 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1110
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001111presetenv <name> <value>
1112 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1113 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1114 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1115 and "unsetenv".
1116
1117resetenv [<name> ...]
1118 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1119 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1120 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1121 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1122 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1123 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1124 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1125 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1126
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001127stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001128 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1129 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1130 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1131 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1132 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1133 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001134 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001135 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1136 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1137 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1138 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001139
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001140server-state-base <directory>
1141 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001142 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1143 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001144
1145server-state-file <file>
1146 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1147 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1148 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1149 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1150 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1151 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1152 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1153 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001154 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1155 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001156
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001157setenv <name> <value>
1158 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1159 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1160 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1161 and "unsetenv".
1162
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001163set-dumpable
1164 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001165 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1166 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1167 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1168 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1169 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1170 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1171 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1172 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1173 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1174 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1175 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1176 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1177 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1178 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1179 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1180 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1181 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001182
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001183ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1184 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1185 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001186 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001187 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001188 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1189 information and recommendations see e.g.
1190 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1191 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1192 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1193 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001194
1195ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1197 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1198 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1199 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1200 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001201 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1202 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1203 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001204 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001205
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001206ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1208 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1209 keyword to see available options.
1210
1211 Example:
1212 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001213 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001214
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001215ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1216 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1217 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001218 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001219 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001220 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1221 information and recommendations see e.g.
1222 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1223 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1224 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1225 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1226 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001227
1228ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1229 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1230 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1231 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1232 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1233 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001234 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1235 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1236 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1237 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001238
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001239ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1240 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1241 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1242 keyword to see available options.
1243
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001244ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1245 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1246 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1247 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001248 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001249 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001250 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1251 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1252 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1253 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001254 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1255 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1256 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1257
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001258ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1259 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1260 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1261 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1262
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001263stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1264 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1265 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1266 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001267 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001268 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001269
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001270 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1271 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1272 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001273
1274stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1275 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1276 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001277 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001278
1279stats maxconn <connections>
1280 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1281 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1282
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001283uid <number>
1284 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1285 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1286 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1287 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1288
1289ulimit-n <number>
1290 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1291 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1292 option.
1293
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001294unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1295 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1296
1297 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1298 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1299 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1300 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1301 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1302 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1303 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1304 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1305 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1306 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1307
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001308unsetenv [<name> ...]
1309 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1310 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1311 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1312 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1313 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1314 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1315 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1316
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001317user <user name>
1318 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1319 See also "uid" and "group".
1320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001321node <name>
1322 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1323
1324 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1325 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1326 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1327 traffic.
1328
1329description <text>
1330 Add a text that describes the instance.
1331
1332 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1333 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1334 "<" and ">" characters.
1335
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100133651degrees-data-file <file path>
1337 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001338 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001339
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001340 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001341 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1342
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000134351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001344 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1345 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1346 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1347
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001348 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001349 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1350
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200135151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001352 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1353 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1354
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001355 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1356 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1357
135851degrees-cache-size <number>
1359 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1360 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1361 By default, this cache is disabled.
1362
1363 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001364 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1365
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001366wurfl-data-file <file path>
1367 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1368 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1369
1370 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1371 with USE_WURFL=1.
1372
1373wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1374 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1375 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1376 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1377
1378 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1379
1380 Valid WURFL properties are:
1381 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1382
1383 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1384 device.
1385
1386 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1387 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1388
1389 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1390 particular web request.
1391
1392 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1393 used Libwurfl API version.
1394
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001395 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1396 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1397
1398 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1399 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1400
1401 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1402
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001403 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1404 with USE_WURFL=1.
1405
1406wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1407 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1408 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1409
1410 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1411 with USE_WURFL=1.
1412
1413wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1414 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1415 thus before the chroot.
1416
1417 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1418 with USE_WURFL=1.
1419
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001420wurfl-cache-size <size>
1421 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1422 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001423 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001424 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001425
1426 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1427 with USE_WURFL=1.
1428
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001429strict-limits
1430 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1431 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1432 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1433 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1434 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1435 keyword.
1436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014373.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001438-----------------------
1439
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001440busy-polling
1441 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1442 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1443 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1444 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1445 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1446 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1447 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1448 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1449 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1450 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1451 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1452 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1453 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1454 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1455 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1456 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1457 "poll" pollers.
1458
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001459max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1460 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1461 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1462 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1463 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1464 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1465 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1466 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1467 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1468
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001469maxconn <number>
1470 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1471 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1472 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001473 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1474 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1475 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1476 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001477 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1478 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1479 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1480 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1481 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1482 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001483
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001484maxconnrate <number>
1485 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1486 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1487 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1488 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1489 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1490 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1491 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1492 fairness.
1493
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001494maxcomprate <number>
1495 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001496 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001497 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1498 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1499 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001500 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001501 default value.
1502
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001503maxcompcpuusage <number>
1504 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1505 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1506 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1507 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1508 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1509 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1510 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1511 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1512
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001513maxpipes <number>
1514 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1515 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1516 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1517 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1518 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1519 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1520
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001521maxsessrate <number>
1522 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1523 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1524 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1525 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1526 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1527 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1528 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1529 fairness.
1530
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001531maxsslconn <number>
1532 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1533 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1534 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1535 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1536 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1537 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1538 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001539 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1540 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1541 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1542 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1543 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1544 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1545 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001546
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001547maxsslrate <number>
1548 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1549 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1550 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1551 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1552 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1553 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1554 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1555 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1556 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1557 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1558
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001559maxzlibmem <number>
1560 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1561 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1562 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001563 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1564 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1565 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1566
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567noepoll
1568 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1569 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001570 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001571
1572nokqueue
1573 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1574 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1575 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1576
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001577noevports
1578 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1579 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1580 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1581 also "nopoll".
1582
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001583nopoll
1584 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1585 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001586 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001587 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1588 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001589
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001590nosplice
1591 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001592 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001593 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001594 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001595 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1596 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1597 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1598 "option splice-response".
1599
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001600nogetaddrinfo
1601 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1602 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1603
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001604noreuseport
1605 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1606 command line argument "-dR".
1607
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001608profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1609 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1610 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1611 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1612 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001613 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001614 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1615 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1616 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1617 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1618
1619 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1620 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1621 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1622 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1623 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001624 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1625 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1626 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1627 CLI.
1628
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001629spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001630 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1631 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1632 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1633 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1634 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1635 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001636
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001637ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001638 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001639 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001640 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1641 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1642 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1643 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1644 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001645 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1646 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001647 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1648 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1649 openssl configuration file uses:
1650 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1651
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001652ssl-mode-async
1653 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001654 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001655 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1656 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1657 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001658 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001659 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001660
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001661tune.buffers.limit <number>
1662 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1663 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1664 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1665 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1666 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001667 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001668 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1669 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1670 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1671 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1672 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1673 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1674 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1675 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1676 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1677
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001678tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1679 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1680 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1681 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1682 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1683
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001684tune.bufsize <number>
1685 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1686 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1687 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1688 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1689 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1690 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1691 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001692 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1693 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1694 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001695 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001696 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1697 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1698 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001699
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001700tune.chksize <number>
1701 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1702 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1703 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1704 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1705 checks whenever possible.
1706
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001707tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1708 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1709 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1710 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1711 this value. The default value is 1.
1712
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001713tune.fail-alloc
1714 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1715 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1716 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1717 gracefully.
1718
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001719tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1720 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1721 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1722 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1723 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1724 change it.
1725
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001726tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1727 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001728 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1729 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001730 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1731 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1732 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1733 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1734 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1735
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001736tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1737 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1738 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1739 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1740 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1741 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1742 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1743 recommended not to change this value.
1744
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001745tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1746 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1747 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1748 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1749 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1750 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1751 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1752 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1753
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001754tune.http.cookielen <number>
1755 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1756 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1757 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1758 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1759 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1760 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1761 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1762 to change this value.
1763
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001764tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001765 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1766 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001767 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001768 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001769 configuration directives too.
1770 The default value is 1024.
1771
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001772tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1773 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1774 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1775 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1776 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1777 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1778 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001779 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1780 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1781 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001782
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001783tune.idletimer <timeout>
1784 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1785 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1786 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1787 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1788 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1789 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001790 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001791 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001792 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1793
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001794tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1795 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1796 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1797 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1798 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1799 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1800 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1801 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1802 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1803 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1804
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001805tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1806 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001807 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001808 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1809 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001810 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001811 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1812 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1813
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001814tune.lua.maxmem
1815 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1816 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1817 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1818 memory.
1819
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001820tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1821 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001822 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1823 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001824 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001825
1826tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1827 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1828 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1829 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1830 check servers.
1831
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001832tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1833 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1834 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1835 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001836 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001837
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001838tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001839 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1840 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1841 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1842 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1843 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1844 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1845 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1846 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1847 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1848 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001849
1850tune.maxpollevents <number>
1851 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1852 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1853 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1854 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1855 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1856
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001857tune.maxrewrite <number>
1858 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1859 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1860 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1861 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1862 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1863 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1864 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1865 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1866 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1867 bufsize.
1868
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001869tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1870 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1871 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1872 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1873 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1874 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1875 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1876 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1877 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1878 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001879 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1880 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001881 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1882 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1883 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1884 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1885 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1886 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1887 setting this parameter to 0.
1888
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001889tune.pipesize <number>
1890 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1891 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1892 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1893 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1894 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1895 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1896
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001897tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1898 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1899 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1900 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1901 default is 20.
1902
1903tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1904 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1905 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1906 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1907 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1908 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1909 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001910 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001911
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001912tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1913tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1914 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1915 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1916 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001917 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001918 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001919 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1920 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1921
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001922tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001923 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001924 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1925 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1926 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1927 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1928
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001929tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001930 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001931 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1932 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1933
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001934tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1935tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1936 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1937 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1938 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001939 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001940 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001941 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1942 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1943 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1944 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1945 notifying haproxy again.
1946
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001947tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001948 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1949 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1950 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001951 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001952 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001953 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001954 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1955 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1956 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001957 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1958 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001959
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001960tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001961 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001962 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1963 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1964 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1965 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1966 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1967
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001968tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1969 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001970 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001971 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1972 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1973 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1974 being used for too long.
1975
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001976tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1977 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1978 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1979 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1980 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1981 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1982 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1983 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1984 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1985 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1986 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001987 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001988 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001989
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001990tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1991 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1992 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1993 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1994 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1995 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1996 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1997 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001998 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1999 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002000
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002001tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2002 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2003 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2004 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2005 1000 entries.
2006
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002007tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2008 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2009 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2010 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2011
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002012tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002013tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002014tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2015tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2016tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002017 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2018 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2019 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2020 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2021 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2022 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2023 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2024 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002025
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002026 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2027 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2028 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2029 all available space is consumed.
2030 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2031 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2032 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002033
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002034tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2035 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002036 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002037 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002038 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002039 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2040
2041tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2042 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2043 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002044 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2045 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020473.3. Debugging
2048--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002049
2050debug
2051 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2052 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2053 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2054 system startup.
2055
2056quiet
2057 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2058 line argument "-q".
2059
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020613.4. Userlists
2062--------------
2063It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2064http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2065it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2066
2067userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002068 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002069 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2070
2071group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002072 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002073 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2074 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2075
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002076user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2077 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002078 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2079 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002080 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2081 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2082 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2083 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002084
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002085 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2086 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2087 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2088 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2089 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2090 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2091 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2092 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2093 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002094
2095 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002096 userlist L1
2097 group G1 users tiger,scott
2098 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002099
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002100 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2101 user scott insecure-password elgato
2102 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002103
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002104 userlist L2
2105 group G1
2106 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002107
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002108 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2109 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2110 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002111
2112 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002113
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002114
21153.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002116----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002117It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2118several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2119instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2120values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2121automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2122In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2123using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2124tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2125reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2126Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2127that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2128each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002129
2130peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002131 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002132 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2133
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002134bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2135 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2136 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2137
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002138disabled
2139 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2140 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2141 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2142
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002143default-bind [param*]
2144 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2145
2146default-server [param*]
2147 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2148
2149 Arguments:
2150 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2151 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2152 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2153 details.
2154
2155
2156 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2157
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002158enable
2159 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2160
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002161log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2162 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2163 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2164 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2165 more details.
2166
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002167peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002168 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2169 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2170 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2171 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2172 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2173 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2174
2175 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2176 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2177
2178 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2179 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2180 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2181 across all peers.
2182
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002183 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2184 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002185
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002186 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2187 "server" keyword explanation below).
2188
2189server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002190 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002191 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2192 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2193 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2194 of this "peers" section).
2195 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2196
2197
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002198 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002199 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002200 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002201 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2202 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2203 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002204
2205 backend mybackend
2206 mode tcp
2207 balance roundrobin
2208 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2209 stick on src
2210
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002211 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2212 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002213
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002214 Example:
2215 peers mypeers
2216 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2217 default-server ssl verify none
2218 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2219 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002220
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002221
2222table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2223 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2224
2225 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2226 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002227 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002228 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2229 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2230 "stick-table" keyword).
2231
2232 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2233 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2234 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2235 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2236 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2237 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2238 of the stick-table name as follows:
2239
2240 peers mypeers
2241 peer A ...
2242 peer B ...
2243 table t1 ...
2244
2245 frontend fe1
2246 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2247
2248 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2249 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2250
2251 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2252 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2253 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2254 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2255 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2256 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2257 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2258
2259 peers mypeers
2260 peer A ...
2261 peer B ...
2262 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2263
2264 backend t1
2265 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2266
2267 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2268 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2269 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2270
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022713.6. Mailers
2272------------
2273It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2274If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2275in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2276
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002277mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002278 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2279 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2280
2281mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2282 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2283
2284 Example:
2285 mailers mymailers
2286 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2287 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2288
2289 backend mybackend
2290 mode tcp
2291 balance roundrobin
2292
2293 email-alert mailers mymailers
2294 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2295 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2296
2297 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2298 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2299
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002300timeout mail <time>
2301 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2302 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2303 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2304 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2305
2306 Example:
2307 mailers mymailers
2308 timeout mail 20s
2309 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002310
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020023113.7. Programs
2312-------------
2313In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2314master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2315managed the same way as the workers.
2316
2317During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2318sequence as a worker:
2319
2320 - the master is re-executed
2321 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2322 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2323 instance of the program
2324
2325During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2326
2327program <name>
2328 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2329 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2330 the management guide).
2331
2332command <command> [arguments*]
2333 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2334 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2335 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2336 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2337
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002338user <user name>
2339 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2340 See also "group".
2341
2342group <group name>
2343 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2344 See also "user".
2345
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002346option start-on-reload
2347no option start-on-reload
2348 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2349 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2350 program section.
2351
2352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023534. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002354----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002355
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002356Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002357 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002358 - frontend <name>
2359 - backend <name>
2360 - listen <name>
2361
2362A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2363its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2364section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002366
2367A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2368connections.
2369
2370A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2371to forward incoming connections.
2372
2373A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2374parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2375
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002376All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2377'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2378case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2379
2380Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2381logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2382proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2383However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2384name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2385
2386Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2387and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002388bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2390modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2391arbitrary criteria.
2392
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002393In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2394a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002395the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002396
2397 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2398 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2399 between responses and new requests.
2400
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002401 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2402 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2403 client-facing connection remains open.
2404
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002405 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2406 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002407
2408The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2409frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2410following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002411weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002412
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002413 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002414
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002415 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2416 ----+-----+-----+----
2417 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2418 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002419 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2420 ----+-----+-----+----
2421 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002422
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024254.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2426--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002427
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002428The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2429limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2430they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2431limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002432marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002433option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002434and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2435with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2436specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002437
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002438
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002439 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2440------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2441acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002442backlog X X X -
2443balance X - X X
2444bind - X X -
2445bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002446capture cookie - X X -
2447capture request header - X X -
2448capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002449compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002450cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002451declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002452default-server X - X X
2453default_backend X X X -
2454description - X X X
2455disabled X X X X
2456dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002457email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002458email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002459email-alert mailers X X X X
2460email-alert myhostname X X X X
2461email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002462enabled X X X X
2463errorfile X X X X
2464errorloc X X X X
2465errorloc302 X X X X
2466-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2467errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002468force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002469filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470fullconn X - X X
2471grace X X X X
2472hash-type X - X X
2473http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002474http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002475http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002476http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002477http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002478http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002479http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002480id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002481ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002482load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002483log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002484log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002485log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002486log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002487max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002488maxconn X X X -
2489mode X X X X
2490monitor fail - X X -
2491monitor-net X X X -
2492monitor-uri X X X -
2493option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2494option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2495option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2496option allbackups (*) X - X X
2497option checkcache (*) X - X X
2498option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2499option contstats (*) X X X -
2500option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2501option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002502-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2503option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002504option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2505option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002506option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002507option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002508option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002509option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002510option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002511option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2512option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2513option httpchk X - X X
2514option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002515option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002516option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002517option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002518option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002519option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002520option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2521option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2522option logasap (*) X X X -
2523option mysql-check X - X X
2524option nolinger (*) X X X X
2525option originalto X X X X
2526option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002527option pgsql-check X - X X
2528option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002529option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002530option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002531option smtpchk X - X X
2532option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2533option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2534option splice-request (*) X X X X
2535option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002536option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002537option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2538option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2539-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002540option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002541option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2542option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2543option tcpka X X X X
2544option tcplog X X X X
2545option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002546external-check command X - X X
2547external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002548persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2549rate-limit sessions X X X -
2550redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002551-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002552retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002553retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002554server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002555server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002556server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002557source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002558stats admin - X X X
2559stats auth X X X X
2560stats enable X X X X
2561stats hide-version X X X X
2562stats http-request - X X X
2563stats realm X X X X
2564stats refresh X X X X
2565stats scope X X X X
2566stats show-desc X X X X
2567stats show-legends X X X X
2568stats show-node X X X X
2569stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002570-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2571stick match - - X X
2572stick on - - X X
2573stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002574stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002575stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002576tcp-check connect - - X X
2577tcp-check expect - - X X
2578tcp-check send - - X X
2579tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002580tcp-request connection - X X -
2581tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002582tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002583tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002584tcp-response content - - X X
2585tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002586timeout check X - X X
2587timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002588timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002589timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002590timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2591timeout http-request X X X X
2592timeout queue X - X X
2593timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002594timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002595timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002596timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002597transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002598unique-id-format X X X -
2599unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002600use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002601use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002602use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002603------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2604 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026074.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2608---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002609
2610This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2611
2612
2613acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2614 Declare or complete an access list.
2615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2616 no | yes | yes | yes
2617 Example:
2618 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2619 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2620 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002622 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002623
2624
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002625backlog <conns>
2626 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2628 yes | yes | yes | no
2629 Arguments :
2630 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2631 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002632 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002633
2634 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2635 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2636 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2637 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2638 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2639 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2640 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2641 backlog parameter.
2642
2643 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2644 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2645 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2646
2647 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2648
2649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002650balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002651balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002652 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2654 yes | no | yes | yes
2655 Arguments :
2656 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2657 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2658 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2659 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2660
2661 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2662 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2663 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2664 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002665 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002666 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002667 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2668 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2669 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2670 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2671 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2672 it, so that you don't worry.
2673
2674 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2675 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2676 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2677 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2678 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2679 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2680 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2681 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002682
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002683 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2684 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2685 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2686 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2687 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2688 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2689 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2690 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2691
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002692 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002693 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002694 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2695 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002696 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002697 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2698 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2699 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2700 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2701 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002702 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2703 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2704 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2705 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2706 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2707 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002708
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002709 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2710 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2711 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2712 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2713 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2714 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2715 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2716 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002717 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002718 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002719 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2720 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2721 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002722
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002723 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2724 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2725 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2726 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2727 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2728 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2729 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2730 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2731 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2732 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2733 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2734 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002736 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002737 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2738 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2739 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2740 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2741 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2742 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2743 URIs start with a leading "/".
2744
2745 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2746 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2747 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2748 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2749
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002750 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002751 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2752
2753 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002754 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2755 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002756 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2757 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2758 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2759 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002760 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002761 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2762 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002763
2764 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2765 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2766 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2767 server will receive the request.
2768
2769 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2770 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2771 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2772 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2773 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002774 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2775 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2776 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002777
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002778 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2779 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2780 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2781 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2782 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002784 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002785 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2786 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2787 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2788
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002789 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2790 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2791 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2792
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002793 random
2794 random(<draws>)
2795 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002796 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2797 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2798 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2799 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002800 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2801 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2802 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2803 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2804 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2805 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2806 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2807 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2808 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2809 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2810 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2811 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2812 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2813 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2814 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2815 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2816 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2817 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2818 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2819 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002820
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002821 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002822 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002823 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2824 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2825 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2826 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2827 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2828 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002829 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002830 used instead.
2831
2832 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2833 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2834 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2835 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2836
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002837 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2838 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2839 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2840
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002841 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002843 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002844 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2845 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002846
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002847 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2848 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2849 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002850
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002851 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002852 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002853 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2854 NTLM relies on.
2855
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002856 Examples :
2857 balance roundrobin
2858 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002859 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002860 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2861 balance hdr(host)
2862 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002863
2864 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2865 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002867 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002868 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2869 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2870 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002871 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002872
2873 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2874 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2875 defaults to 16 kB.
2876
2877 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2878 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2879
2880 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2881 Round Robin.
2882
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002883 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002884 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2885 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2886 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2887
2888 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2889
2890 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002891 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002892 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2893 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2894 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002895
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002896 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002897
2898
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002899bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2900bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002901 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2903 no | yes | yes | no
2904 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002905 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2906 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2907 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2908 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002909 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002910 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2911 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2912 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2913 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2914 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2915 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2916 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002917 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2918 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2919 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2920 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2921 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2922 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2923 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002924 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2925 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2926 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002927 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2928 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2929 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2930 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002931 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2932 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2933 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002934
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002935 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2936 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002937 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2938 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2939 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002940 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2941 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2942 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2943 the range.
2944
2945 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2946 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2947 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2948 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2949 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2950 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2951 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002952 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002953 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002955 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002956 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002957 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2958 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2959 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2960 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2961 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2962 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2963
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002964 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2965 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2966 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2967 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002968
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002969 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2970 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2971 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2972 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2973 in a frontend.
2974
2975 Example :
2976 listen http_proxy
2977 bind :80,:443
2978 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002979 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002980
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002981 listen http_https_proxy
2982 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002983 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002984
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002985 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2986 bind ipv6@:80
2987 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2988 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2989
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002990 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002991 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002992
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002993 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2994 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2995 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2996 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2997 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2998
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002999 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003000 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003001
3002
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003003bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003004 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3006 yes | yes | yes | yes
3007 Arguments :
3008 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3009 may be used to override a default value.
3010
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003011 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003012 option may be combined with other numbers.
3013
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003014 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003015 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3016 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3017 missing from all processes.
3018
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003019 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003020 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003021 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3022 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3023 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3024 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3025 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003026 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003027
3028 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3029 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3030 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3031 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3032 and 'even' instances.
3033
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003034 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3035 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3036 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3037 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003038
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003039 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3040 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3041
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003042 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3043 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3044 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3045
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003046 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3047 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3048
3049 Example :
3050 listen app_ip1
3051 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003052 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003053
3054 listen app_ip2
3055 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003056 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003057
3058 listen management
3059 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003060 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003061
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003062 listen management
3063 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3064 bind-process 1-4
3065
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003066 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003067
3068
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003069capture cookie <name> len <length>
3070 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3072 no | yes | yes | no
3073 Arguments :
3074 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3075 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3076 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3077 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003078 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003079
3080 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3081 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3082 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3083 right if it exceeds <length>.
3084
3085 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3086 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3087 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3088 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3089
3090 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3091 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3092 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3093
3094 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3095 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3096 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003097 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3098 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3099 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003100
3101 Example:
3102 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3103
3104 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003105 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003106
3107
3108capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003109 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3111 no | yes | yes | no
3112 Arguments :
3113 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003114 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003115 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3116 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3117 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3118
3119 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3120 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3121 it exceeds <length>.
3122
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003123 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3125 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003126 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3127 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3128 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3129 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003130 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003131 environments to find where the request came from.
3132
3133 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3134 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3135 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3136 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003137
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003138 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3139 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3140 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3141 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3142 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143
3144 Example:
3145 capture request header Host len 15
3146 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003147 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003149 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003150 about logging.
3151
3152
3153capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003154 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3156 no | yes | yes | no
3157 Arguments :
3158 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003159 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003160 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3161 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3162 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3163
3164 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3165 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3166 it exceeds <length>.
3167
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003168 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3170 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3171 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003172 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3173 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3174 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3175 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003176
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003177 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3178 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3179 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3180 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3181 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003182
3183 Example:
3184 capture response header Content-length len 9
3185 capture response header Location len 15
3186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003187 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003188 about logging.
3189
3190
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003191compression algo <algorithm> ...
3192compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003193compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003194 Enable HTTP compression.
3195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3196 yes | yes | yes | yes
3197 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003198 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3199 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3200 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3201
3202 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003203 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3204 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3205 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003206
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003207 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003208 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003209
3210 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3211 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3212 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3213 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3214 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003215 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003216
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003217 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3218 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3219 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3220 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3221 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3222 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3223 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003224 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003225
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003226 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003227 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003228 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3229 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3230 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3231 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3232 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003233
3234 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3235 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3236 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3237 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3238 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003239 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3240 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3241 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3242 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3243 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003244 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3245 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003246
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003247 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003248 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3249 "Accept-Encoding" header
3250 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003251 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003252 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3253 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3254 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3255 "multipart"
3256 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3257 header
3258 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3259 and later
3260 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3261 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003262 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003263
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003264 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003265
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003266 Examples :
3267 compression algo gzip
3268 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003269
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003270
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003271cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003272 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3273 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003274 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3277 yes | no | yes | yes
3278 Arguments :
3279 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3280 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3281 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3282 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3283 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3284 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003285 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003286 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3287 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3288
3289 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3290 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3291 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3292 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3293 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3294 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003295 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3296 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003297 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003298 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3299 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300
3301 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003302 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003303
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003304 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003305 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003306 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003307 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003308 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3309 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3310 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3311 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3312 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3313 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3314 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003315
3316 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3317 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3318 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3319 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3320 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3321 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3322 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3323 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3324 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003325 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003326 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3327 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3328 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003329
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003330 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3331 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3332 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003333 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3334 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3335 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3336 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003337 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3338 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3339 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003340
3341 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3342 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3343 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3344 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3345 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3346 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3347 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3348 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3349 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3350
3351 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3352 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3353 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3354 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3355 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3356 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3357 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3358 persistence cookie in the cache.
3359 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3360
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003361 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3362 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3363 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3364 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3365 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003366 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003367 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3368 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3369 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3370 they logout.
3371
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003372 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3373 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3374 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3375 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3376
3377 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3378 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3379 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3380 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3381 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3382 this attribute.
3383
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003384 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003385 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003386 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3387 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3388 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3389 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3390 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3391 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003392
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003393 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3394 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3395 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3396 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3397 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3398 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3399 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3400 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003401 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003402 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3403 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3404 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3405 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3406 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3407 the site.
3408
3409 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3410 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3411 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3412 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3413 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3414 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3415 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3416 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3417 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3418 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3419 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3420 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3421 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003422 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003423 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3424 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3425
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003426 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3427 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3428 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3429 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3430 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3431 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003433 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3434 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3435 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3436 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003437
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003438 Examples :
3439 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3440 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3441 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003442 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003443
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003444 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003445
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003446
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003447declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3448 Declares a capture slot.
3449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3450 no | yes | yes | no
3451 Arguments:
3452 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3453
3454 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3455 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3456 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3457 for use in the response.
3458
3459 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003460 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003461 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3462
3463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003464default-server [param*]
3465 Change default options for a server in a backend
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 yes | no | yes | yes
3468 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003469 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3470 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3471 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3472 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003473
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003474 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003475 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3476
3477 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003478
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003480default_backend <backend>
3481 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3483 yes | yes | yes | no
3484 Arguments :
3485 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3486
3487 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3488 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3489 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3490 will catch all undetermined requests.
3491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003492 Example :
3493
3494 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3495 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3496 default_backend dynamic
3497
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003498 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003499
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003501description <string>
3502 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3504 no | yes | yes | yes
3505 Arguments : string
3506
3507 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3508 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3509 it describes.
3510 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3511
3512
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003513disabled
3514 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3516 yes | yes | yes | yes
3517 Arguments : none
3518
3519 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3520 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3521 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3522 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3523 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3524 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3525 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3526
3527 See also : "enabled"
3528
3529
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003530dispatch <address>:<port>
3531 Set a default server address
3532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3533 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003534 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003535
3536 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3537 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3538 during start-up.
3539
3540 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3541 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3542 possible with normal servers.
3543
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003544 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003545 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3546 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3547 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3548 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3549
3550 See also : "server"
3551
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003552
3553dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3554 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3556 yes | no | yes | yes
3557 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3558
3559 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003560 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003561 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3562 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003563 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003564 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003566enabled
3567 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3569 yes | yes | yes | yes
3570 Arguments : none
3571
3572 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3573 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3574
3575 See also : "disabled"
3576
3577
3578errorfile <code> <file>
3579 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3581 yes | yes | yes | yes
3582 Arguments :
3583 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003584 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3585 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586
3587 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003588 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003589 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003590 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3591 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003592
3593 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3594 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3595 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3596
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003597 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3598
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003599 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3600 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3601 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3602 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3603
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003604 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3605 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003606 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003607 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3608 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3609 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003611 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3612 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3613 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003614 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003615 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3616
3617 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3618
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003619 Example :
3620 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003621 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003622 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3623 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3624
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003625
3626errorloc <code> <url>
3627errorloc302 <code> <url>
3628 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3630 yes | yes | yes | yes
3631 Arguments :
3632 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003633 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3634 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003635
3636 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3637 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3638 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3639 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003640 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003641
3642 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3643 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3644 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3645
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003646 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3647
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003648 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3649 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3650 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3651 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003652 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003653 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3654 request.
3655
3656 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3657
3658
3659errorloc303 <code> <url>
3660 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3662 yes | yes | yes | yes
3663 Arguments :
3664 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003665 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3666 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003667
3668 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3669 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3670 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3671 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003672 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003673
3674 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3675 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3676 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3677
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003678 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3679
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003680 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3681 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3682 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3683 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003684 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003685
3686 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3687
3688
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003689email-alert from <emailaddr>
3690 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003691 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003692 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3693 yes | yes | yes | yes
3694
3695 Arguments :
3696
3697 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3698
3699 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3700 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3701
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003702 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003703 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3704 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003705
3706
3707email-alert level <level>
3708 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3709 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3710 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3711 yes | yes | yes | yes
3712
3713 Arguments :
3714
3715 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3716 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3717 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3718
3719 By default level is alert
3720
3721 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3722 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3723 for the proxy.
3724
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003725 Alerts are sent when :
3726
3727 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3728 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3729 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3730 is notice or lower
3731 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3732 and a health check status update occurs
3733
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003734 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3735 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003736 section 3.6 about mailers.
3737
3738
3739email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3740 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3741 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3742 yes | yes | yes | yes
3743
3744 Arguments :
3745
3746 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3747
3748 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3749 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3750
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003751 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3752 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003753
3754
3755email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3756 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3757 mailers.
3758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3759 yes | yes | yes | yes
3760
3761 Arguments :
3762
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003763 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003764
3765 By default the systems hostname is used.
3766
3767 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3768 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3769 for the proxy.
3770
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003771 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3772 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003773
3774
3775email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003776 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003777 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3779 yes | yes | yes | yes
3780
3781 Arguments :
3782
3783 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3784
3785 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3786 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3787
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003788 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003789 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3790
3791
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003792force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3793 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003795 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003796
3797 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3798 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3799 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3800 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3801 marked down for maintenance operations.
3802
3803 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3804 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3805 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3806 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3807 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3808 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3809 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3810 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3811 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3812
3813 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3814 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3815 is used.
3816
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003817 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003818 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003819
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003820
3821filter <name> [param*]
3822 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3824 no | yes | yes | yes
3825 Arguments :
3826 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3827 referenced in section 9.
3828
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003829 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003830 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003831 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3832 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003833
3834 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3835 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3836
3837 Example:
3838 listen
3839 bind *:80
3840
3841 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3842 filter compression
3843 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3844
3845 compression algo gzip
3846 compression offload
3847
3848 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3849
3850 See also : section 9.
3851
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003852
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003853fullconn <conns>
3854 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | no | yes | yes
3857 Arguments :
3858 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3859 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3860
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003861 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003862 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003863 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003864 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3865 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3866 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3867 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3868 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003869 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003870
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003871 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3872 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003873 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3874 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3875 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003876
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003877 Example :
3878 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3879 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3880 # connections.
3881 backend dynamic
3882 fullconn 10000
3883 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3884 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3885
3886 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3887
3888
3889grace <time>
3890 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003892 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003893 Arguments :
3894 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3895 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3896 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3897
3898 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3899 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003900 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003901 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3902
3903 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3904 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3905 simplify it.
3906
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003907
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003908hash-balance-factor <factor>
3909 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 yes | no | no | yes
3912 Arguments :
3913 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3914 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003915 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003916
3917 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3918 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3919 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3920 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3921 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3922 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3923 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3924
3925 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3926 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3927 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3928 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3929 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3930
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003931 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3932 consistent hashing mechanism.
3933
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003934 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3935
3936
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003937hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003938 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3940 yes | no | yes | yes
3941 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003942 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3943 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003944
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003945 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3946 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3947 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3948 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3949 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3950 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3951 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3952 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3953 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3954 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003955
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003956 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3957 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3958 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3959 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3960 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3961 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3962 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3963 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3964 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3965 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3966 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3967 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3968 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003969 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3970 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003971
3972 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3973
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003974 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003975 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3976 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3977 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003978 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3979 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3980 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003981
3982 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3983 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003984 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3985 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3986 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3987 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3988
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003989 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3990 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3991 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3992 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3993 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3994 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3995 parameter.
3996
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003997 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3998 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3999 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4000 used on strings.
4001
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004002 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4003
4004 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4005 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4006 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4007 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4008 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4009 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4010 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4011 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4012 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4013 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4014 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4015 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004016
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004017 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4018 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4019 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004020
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004021 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004022
4023
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004024http-check disable-on-404
4025 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004027 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004028 Arguments : none
4029
4030 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4031 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4032 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4033 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4034 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4035 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4036 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4037 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004038 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4039 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4040 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4041
4042 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4043
4044
4045http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004046 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004048 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004049 Arguments :
4050 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4051 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004052 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004053 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4054 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4055 details on the supported keywords.
4056
4057 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4058 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4059 with the usual backslash ('\').
4060
4061 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4062 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4063 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4064 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4065 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4066
4067 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004068 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004069 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4070 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4071 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4072
4073 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004074 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004075 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4076 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4077 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4078 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4079
4080 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004081 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004082 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4083 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4084 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4085 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4086 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004087 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004088 trace).
4089
4090 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004091 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004092 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4093 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4094 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4095 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4096 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004097 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004098
4099 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4100 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4101 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4102 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4103 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4104 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4105 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4106 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4107
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004108 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4109 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4110 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4111
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004112 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4113 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4114
4115 Examples :
4116 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004117 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004118
4119 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004120 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004121
4122 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004123 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004124
4125 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004126 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004127
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004128 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004129
4130
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004131http-check send-state
4132 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | no | yes | yes
4135 Arguments : none
4136
4137 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4138 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4139 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4140 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4141 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4142
4143 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4144 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4145 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4146 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4147 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004148 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4149 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4150 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4151
4152 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4153 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4154 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4155
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004156 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4157 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4158 checked in multiple backends.
4159
4160 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4161 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4162
4163 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4164 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4165 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4166 one fails.
4167
4168 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4169 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4170 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4171
4172 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4173 server's queue.
4174
4175 Example of a header received by the application server :
4176 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4177 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4178
4179 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004181
4182http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004183 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4184
4185 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4186 no | yes | yes | yes
4187
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004188 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4189 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4190 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4191 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4192 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004193
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004194 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4195 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004197 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004199 Example:
4200 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4201 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4202 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004204 http-request allow if nagios
4205 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4206 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4207 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004209 Example:
4210 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4211 acl add path /addacl
4212 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004214 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004216 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4217 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004219 Example:
4220 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4221 acl setmap path /setmap
4222 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004224 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004226 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4227 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004228
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004229 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4230 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004232http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004234 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4235 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4236 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4237 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4238 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4239 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4240 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4241 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004243http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004245 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4246 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4247 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4248 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4249 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4250 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4251 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4252 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004253
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004254http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004256 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4257 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004258
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004259
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004260http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4263 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4264 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4265 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4266 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004267
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004268 Example:
4269 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4270 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004271
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004272http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004273
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004274 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004276http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4277 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004279 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4280 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4281 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4282 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4283 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4284 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4285 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4286 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4287 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4290 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4291 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4292 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4293 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4294 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004296http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004297
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004298 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4299 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4300 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4301 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4302 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4303 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004307 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4312 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4313 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4314 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4315 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4316 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4321 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4322 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4323 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4324 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004325
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004326http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4327 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4328 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4329 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4330
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004331http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4332
4333 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4334 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4335 pointed by <resolvers>.
4336 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4337 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4338 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4339 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4340 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4341 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4342 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4343 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4344 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4345 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4346 to 0.0.0.0.
4347
4348 Example:
4349 resolvers mydns
4350 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4351 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4352 timeout retry 1s
4353 hold valid 10s
4354 hold nx 3s
4355 hold other 3s
4356 hold obsolete 0s
4357 accepted_payload_size 8192
4358
4359 frontend fe
4360 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4361 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4362 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4363
4364 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4365 # which mean DNS resolution error
4366 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4367
4368 default_backend be
4369
4370 backend b_503
4371 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4372 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4373 # 503 error page to end users
4374
4375 backend be
4376 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4377 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4378 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4379 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4380 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4381
4382 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4383 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4384
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004385http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4386
4387 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4388 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4389 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4390 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004391 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4392 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004393
4394 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004398 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4399 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4400 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4401 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4402 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004404http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004406 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4407 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4408 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4409 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004411http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4412 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004413
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004414 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4415 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4416 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4417 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4418 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4419 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004420
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004421 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4422 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4423 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4424 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4425 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004426
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004427 Example:
4428 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4429
4430 # applied to:
4431 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4432
4433 # outputs:
4434 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4435
4436 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004437
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004438 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4439
4440 # applied to:
4441 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004442
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004443 # outputs:
4444 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004445
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004446http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4447 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4448
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004449 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4450 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4451 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4452 against.
4453
4454 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4455 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4456 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004457
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004458 Example:
4459 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4460 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004461
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004462 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4463 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004464
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004465 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4466 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4467 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4468 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004470http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4471 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004472
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004473 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4474 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4475 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4476 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004477
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004478 Example:
4479 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004480
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004481 # applied to:
4482 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004483
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004484 # outputs:
4485 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004487http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4488http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004490 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4491 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4492 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004493
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004494http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4495 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004496
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004497 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4498 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4499 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4500 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004502http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004504 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4505 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4506 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4507 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4508 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004509
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004510 Arguments:
4511 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4512 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004514 Example:
4515 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4516 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004518 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4519 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004521http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004523 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4524 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4525 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004526
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004527 Arguments:
4528 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4529 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004531 Example:
4532 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4533 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004535 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4536 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4537 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004538
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004539http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004540
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004541 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4542 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4543 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4544 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4545 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004547 Example:
4548 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4549 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4550 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4551 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4552 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4553 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4554 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4555 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4556 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004558http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4561 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4562 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4563 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4564 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004565
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004566http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4567 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004569 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4570 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4571 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4572 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4573 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4574 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4575 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4576 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4577 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004581 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4582 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4583 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4584 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4585 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4586 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4587 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004589http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004591 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4592 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4593 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004595http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004597 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4598 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4599 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4600 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4601 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4602 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4603 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4604 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004608 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4609 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4610 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4611 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4612 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4613 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004615 Example :
4616 # prepend the host name before the path
4617 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004621 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4622 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4623 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4624 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4625 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004627http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4630 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4631 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4632 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4633 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4634 values have higher priority.
4635 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4636 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4637 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4638 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4639 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004643 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4644 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4645 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4646 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4647 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4648 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4649 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004651 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004652
4653 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4655 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004657http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4658 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4659 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4660 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4661 privacy.
4662
4663 Arguments :
4664 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4665 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004666
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004667 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004668 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4669 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4670
4671 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4672 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4673
4674http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4675
4676 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4677 expression.
4678
4679 Arguments:
4680 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4681 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004682
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004683 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004684 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4685 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4686
4687 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4688 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4689 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4690
4691http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4692
4693 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4694 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4695 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4696 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4697 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4698 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4699 information from the request.
4700
4701 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4702
4703http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4704
4705 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4706 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4707 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4708 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4709 path and the query string.
4710 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4711
4712http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4713
4714 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4715 inline.
4716
4717 Arguments:
4718 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4719 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4720 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4721 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4722 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4723 (request and response)
4724 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4725 processing
4726 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4727 processing
4728 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4729 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4730 and '_'.
4731
4732 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4733 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004734
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004735 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004736 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004738http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4739 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004741 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4742 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4743 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4744 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4745 agent name must be used.
4746
4747 Arguments:
4748 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4749
4750 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4751 configuration.
4752
4753http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4754
4755 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4756 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4757 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4758 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4759 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4760 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4761 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4762 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4763 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4764 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4765 action.
4766 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4767 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4768 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4769 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4770 you fully understand how it works.
4771
4772http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4773
4774 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4775 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4776 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4777 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4778 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4779 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4780 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4781 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4782 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4783 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4784 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4785 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4786 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4787
4788http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4789http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4790http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4791
4792 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4793 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4794 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4795 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4796 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4797 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4798 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4799 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4800 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4801 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4802 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4803 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4804
4805 Arguments :
4806 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4807 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4808 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4809 select which table entry to update the counters.
4810
4811 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4812 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4813 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4814 that table until the session ends.
4815
4816 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4817 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4818 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4819 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4820 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4821 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4822 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4823 useful information.
4824
4825 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4826 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4827 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4828 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4829 checks that make use of it.
4830
4831http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4832
4833 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004834
4835 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004836 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004837
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004838http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4839
4840 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4841 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4842 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4843 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4844 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4845 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4846
4847 Arguments :
4848 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4849
4850 Example:
4851 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4852
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004853http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004854
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004855 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4856 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4857 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004858
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004859
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004860http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004861 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4862
4863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4864 no | yes | yes | yes
4865
4866 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4867 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4868 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4869 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4870 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4871 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4872
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004873 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4874 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004875
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004876 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004877
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004878 Example:
4879 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004880
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004881 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4884 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004886 Example:
4887 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004888
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004889 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004890
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004891 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4892 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004893
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004894 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4895 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004896
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004897http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004898
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004899 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4900 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4901 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4902 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4903 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4904 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4905 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4906 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004908http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004910 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4911 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4912 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4913 example, or to pass some internal information.
4914 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4915 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4916 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004917
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004918http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004919
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004920 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4921 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004922
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004923http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004924
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004925 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004926
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004927http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004928
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004929 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4930 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4931 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4932 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4933 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4934 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4935 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004937 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4938 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4939 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4940 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4941 keyword.
4942 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4943 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004945http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004947 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4948 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4949 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4950 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4951 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4952 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004956 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004958http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004960 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4961 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4962 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4963 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4964 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4965 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004967http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004968
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004969 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4970 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004972http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004974 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4975 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4976 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4977 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4978 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4979 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004981http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4982 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004983
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004984 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
4985 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004986
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004987 Example:
4988 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004990 # applied to:
4991 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004993 # outputs:
4994 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004995
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004996 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004998http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4999 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005000
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005001 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5002 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005003
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005004 Example:
5005 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005007 # applied to:
5008 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005010 # outputs:
5011 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005012
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005013http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5014http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005016 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5017 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5018 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005019
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005020http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5021 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005022
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005023 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5024 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5025 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5026 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005028http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005030 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5031 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5032 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5033 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5034 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036 Arguments:
5037 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005039 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5040 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005042http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005044 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5045 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5046 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005048http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5049
5050 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5051 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5052 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5053 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5054 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5055
5056http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5057
5058 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5059 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5060 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5061 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5062 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5063 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5064 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5065 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5066 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5067
5068http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5069
5070 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5071 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5072 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5073 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5074 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5075 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5076 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5077
5078http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5079
5080 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5081 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5082 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5083 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5084 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5085 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5086 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5087 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5088
5089http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5090 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5091
5092 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5093 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5094 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5095 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005096
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005097 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005098 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5099 http-response set-status 431
5100 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5101 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005103http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005105 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5106 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5107 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5108 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5109 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5110 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5111 based on some information from the request.
5112
5113 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5114
5115http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5116
5117 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5118 inline.
5119
5120 Arguments:
5121 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5122 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5123 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5124 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5125 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5126 (request and response)
5127 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5128 processing
5129 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5130 processing
5131 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5132 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5133 and '_'.
5134
5135 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5136 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005137
5138 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005139 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005141http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005143 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5144 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5145 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5146 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5147 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5148 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5149 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5150 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5151 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5152 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5153 action.
5154 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5155 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5156 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5157 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5158 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005160http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5161http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5162http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005164 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5165 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5166 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5167 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5168 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5169 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5170
5171http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5172
5173 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5174 about <var-name>.
5175
5176 Example:
5177 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5178
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005179
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005180http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5181 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5182
5183 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5184 yes | no | yes | yes
5185
5186 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005187 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5188 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5189 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005190
5191 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5192
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005193 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5194 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5195 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5196 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5197 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5198 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5199 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5200 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5201 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5202 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005203
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005204 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5205 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5206 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5207 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5208 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5209 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5210 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5211 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005212
5213 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5214 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5215 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5216 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5217 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5218 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5219 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5220 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005221 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005222 downsides of rare connection failures.
5223
5224 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5225 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5226 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5227 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5228 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5229 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005230 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005231 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5232 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5233 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5234 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5235 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5236
5237 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005238 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5239 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5240 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005241
5242 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005243 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005244
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005245 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5246 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005247
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005248 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005249
5250 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5251 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5252 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5253
5254 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5255
5256
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005257http-send-name-header [<header>]
5258 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005259 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5260 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005261 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005262 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5263
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005264 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5265 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5266 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5267 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5268 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5269 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5270 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5271 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5272 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5273 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5274 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5275 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5276 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5277 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5278 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5279 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005280
5281 See also : "server"
5282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005283id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005284 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5286 no | yes | yes | yes
5287 Arguments : none
5288
5289 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5290 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5291 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005292
5293
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005294ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5295 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005297 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005298
5299 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5300 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5301 and running).
5302
5303 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5304 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5305 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005306 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005307 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5308
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005309 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5310 "unless" condition is met.
5311
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005312 Example:
5313 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5314 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5315 ignore-persist if url_static
5316
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005317 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5318
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005319load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5320 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5322 yes | no | yes | yes
5323
5324 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5325 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5326 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005327 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005328 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5329 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5330 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5331 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005333 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005334 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005335 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005336
5337 Arguments:
5338 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5339 named "server-state-file".
5340
5341 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5342 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5343 name is used as a file name.
5344
5345 none don't load any stat for this backend
5346
5347 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005348 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5349 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5350 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005351 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005352 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005353
5354 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5355 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5356
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005357 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005358
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005359 global
5360 stats socket /tmp/socket
5361 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005362
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005363 defaults
5364 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005365
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005366 backend bk
5367 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5368 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005369
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005370
5371 Then one can run :
5372
5373 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5374
5375 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5376
5377 1
5378 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5379 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5380 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5381
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005382 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005383
5384 global
5385 stats socket /tmp/socket
5386 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5387
5388 defaults
5389 load-server-state-from-file local
5390
5391 backend bk
5392 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5393 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5394
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005395
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005396 Then one can run :
5397
5398 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5399
5400 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5401
5402 1
5403 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5404 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5405 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5406
5407 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5408 "show servers state"
5409
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005410
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005411log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005412log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5413 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005414no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005415 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5417 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005418
5419 Prefix :
5420 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5421 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5422 prefix does not allow arguments.
5423
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005424 Arguments :
5425 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5426 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5427 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5428 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5429 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5430 parameter.
5431
5432 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5433 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5434
5435 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5436 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5437 standard syslog port).
5438
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005439 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5440 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5441 standard syslog port).
5442
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005443 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5444 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5445 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005446 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005447
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005448 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5449 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5450 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5451 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5452 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5453 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5454 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5455 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5456 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5457 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5458 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5459 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5460 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5461 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5462 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5463 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005464 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5465 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005466
5467 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5468 and "fd@2", see above.
5469
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005470 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5471 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5472 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5473 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5474 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5475 having the logs instantly available.
5476
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005477 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5478 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005479
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005480 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5481 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5482 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5483 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5484 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5485 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5486 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5487 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5488 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5489 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005490 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005491
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005492 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5493 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5494 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5495 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5496 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5497
5498 <sample_size>
5499 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5500 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5501 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5502 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5503 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5504
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005505 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5506 one of the following :
5507
5508 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5509 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5510
5511 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5512 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5513
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005514 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5515 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5516 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5517 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5518 systemd logger consumes.
5519
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005520 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5521 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5522 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5523 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5524
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005525 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5526
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005527 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5528 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5529 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5530
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005531 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5532 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5533 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5534 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005535
5536 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5537 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5538 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005539 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5540 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5541 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5542 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5543 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005544
5545 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5546
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005547 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5548 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5549 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005550
5551 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5552 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5553 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5554 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5555
5556 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5557 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005558
5559 Example :
5560 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005561 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5562 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5563 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005564 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5565 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005566 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005567
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005568
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005569log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005570 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5571 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5572 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005573
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005574 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5575 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5576 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5577 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5578 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005579
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005580 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5581 "option httplog" directives.
5582
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005583log-format-sd <string>
5584 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | yes | yes | no
5587
5588 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5589 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5590 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5591 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5592 which covers the log format string in depth.
5593
5594 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5595 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5596
5597 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5598 log format to "rfc5424".
5599
5600 Example :
5601 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5602
5603
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005604log-tag <string>
5605 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5606 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5607 yes | yes | yes | yes
5608
5609 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5610 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5611 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5612 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5613 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5614 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5615 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5616 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5617 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005618
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005619max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5620 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5621 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5622 yes | no | yes | yes
5623
5624 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5625 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5626 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5627 servers.
5628
5629 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5630 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5631 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5632 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5633 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005634 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005635 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5636 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5637 picking a different server.
5638
5639 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5640 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5641 even if they have to be queued.
5642
5643 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5644 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5645
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005646max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5647 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5648 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5649 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005650
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005651maxconn <conns>
5652 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5654 yes | yes | yes | no
5655 Arguments :
5656 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5657 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5658 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5659 closes.
5660
5661 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5662 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5663 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5664 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005665 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5666 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5667 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5668 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005669
5670 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5671 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5672 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5673
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005674 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5675 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005676
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005677 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5678
5679
5680mode { tcp|http|health }
5681 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5683 yes | yes | yes | yes
5684 Arguments :
5685 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5686 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5687 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5688 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5689
5690 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5691 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5692 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5693 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5694 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5695
5696 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005697 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5698 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5699 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5700 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5701 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5702 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5703 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005704
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005705 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5706 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5707 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005708
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005709 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005710 defaults http_instances
5711 mode http
5712
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005713 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005714
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005715
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005716monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005717 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5719 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005720 Arguments :
5721 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5722 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005723 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005724 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5725 backend and its backup.
5726
5727 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5728 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5729 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5730 servers in a list of backends.
5731
5732 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5733 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5734 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5735 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5736 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5737 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5738 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005739 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5740 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005741
5742 Example:
5743 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005744 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005745 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5746 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5747 monitor-uri /site_alive
5748 monitor fail if site_dead
5749
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005750 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005751
5752
5753monitor-net <source>
5754 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 yes | yes | yes | no
5757 Arguments :
5758 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5759 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5760 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5761 followed by a mask.
5762
5763 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5764 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005765 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005766 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5767
5768 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5769 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5770 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5771 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005772 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5773 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5774 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005775
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005776 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5777 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5778 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5779 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5780 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5781 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005782
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005783 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5784 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005785
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005786 Example :
5787 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5788 frontend www
5789 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5790
5791 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5792
5793
5794monitor-uri <uri>
5795 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5797 yes | yes | yes | no
5798 Arguments :
5799 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5800 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5801
5802 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5803 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5804 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5805 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5806 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5807 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5808 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5809 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5810
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005811 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005812 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5813 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5814 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5815 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5816 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5817 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005818
5819 Example :
5820 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5821 frontend www
5822 mode http
5823 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5824
5825 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5826
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005827
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005828option abortonclose
5829no option abortonclose
5830 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5832 yes | no | yes | yes
5833 Arguments : none
5834
5835 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5836 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5837 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5838 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005839 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005840 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5841 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5842 encountered while delivering the response.
5843
5844 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5845 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5846 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5847 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5848 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5849 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005850 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005851 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005852 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005853 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5854 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5855 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5856
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005857 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5858 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005859 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5860 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5861 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5862 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5863 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5864 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005865 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005866
5867 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5868 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5869
5870 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5871
5872
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005873option accept-invalid-http-request
5874no option accept-invalid-http-request
5875 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5877 yes | yes | yes | no
5878 Arguments : none
5879
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005880 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005881 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005882 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005883 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5884 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5885 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5886 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5887 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005888 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5889 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5890 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5891 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005892 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005893 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005894 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5895 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5896 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005897
5898 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5899 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5900 been confirmed.
5901
5902 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5903 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005904 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5905 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005906 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5907
5908 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5909 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5910
5911 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5912 stats socket.
5913
5914
5915option accept-invalid-http-response
5916no option accept-invalid-http-response
5917 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5919 yes | no | yes | yes
5920 Arguments : none
5921
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005922 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005923 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005924 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005925 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5926 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5927 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5928 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5929 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005930 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5931 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5932 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005933
5934 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5935 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5936 been confirmed.
5937
5938 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5939 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5940 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5941 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5942
5943 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5944 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5945
5946 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5947 stats socket.
5948
5949
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005950option allbackups
5951no option allbackups
5952 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5954 yes | no | yes | yes
5955 Arguments : none
5956
5957 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5958 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5959 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5960 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5961 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5962 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5963 order between the backup servers anymore.
5964
5965 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5966 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5967
5968 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5969 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5970
5971
5972option checkcache
5973no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005974 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5976 yes | no | yes | yes
5977 Arguments : none
5978
5979 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5980 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005981 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005982 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5983 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005984 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005985
5986 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005987 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005988 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005989 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5990 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005991 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005992 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005993 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5994 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005995 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005996 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5997 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005998 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005999 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6000 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6001 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6002 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6003 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6004 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6005 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6006 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6007 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6008
6009 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006010 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6011 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6012 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6013 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006014
6015 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6016 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006017 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006018 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006019
6020 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6021 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6022
6023
6024option clitcpka
6025no option clitcpka
6026 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6028 yes | yes | yes | no
6029 Arguments : none
6030
6031 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6032 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006033 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006034 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6035
6036 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6037 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6038 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6039 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6040
6041 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6042 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6043 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6044 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6045 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6046
6047 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6048
6049 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6050 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6051 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6052
6053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6055
6056 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6057
6058
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006059option contstats
6060 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6062 yes | yes | yes | no
6063 Arguments : none
6064
6065 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6066 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6067 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6068 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006069 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6070 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6071 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6072 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6073 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006074
6075
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006076option dontlog-normal
6077no option dontlog-normal
6078 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6080 yes | yes | yes | no
6081 Arguments : none
6082
6083 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6084 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6085 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6086 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6087 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6088 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6089 logged.
6090
6091 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6092 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6093 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006095 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006096 logging.
6097
6098
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006099option dontlognull
6100no option dontlognull
6101 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6103 yes | yes | yes | no
6104 Arguments : none
6105
6106 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6107 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6108 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6109 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6110 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6111 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006112 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6113 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6114 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006115
6116 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006117 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006118 would not be logged.
6119
6120 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6121 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6122
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006123 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6124 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006125
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006126
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006127option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006128 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6130 yes | yes | yes | yes
6131 Arguments :
6132 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6133 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006134 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006135 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006136
6137 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6138 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6139 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6140 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6141 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6142 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6143 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006144 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6145 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6146 possible that the client has already brought one.
6147
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006148 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006149 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006150 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006151 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006152 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006153 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006154
6155 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6156 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6157 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6158 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6159 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6160 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6161 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6162
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006163 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6164 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6165 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6166 are under the control of the end-user.
6167
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006168 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006169 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6170 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006171 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6172 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6173 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006174
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006175 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006176 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6177 frontend www
6178 mode http
6179 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6180
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006181 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6182 backend www
6183 mode http
6184 option forwardfor header X-Client
6185
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006186 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006187 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006188
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006189
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006190option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6191no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6192 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6194 yes | yes | yes | no
6195 Arguments : none
6196
6197 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6198 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6199 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6200 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6201 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6202 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6203 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6204
6205 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6206 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6207 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6208 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6209 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6210 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6211 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6212 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6213 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6214 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6215
6216 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6217
6218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6220
6221 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6222 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6223
6224
6225option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6226no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6227 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6229 yes | no | yes | yes
6230 Arguments : none
6231
6232 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6233 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6234 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6235 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6236 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6237 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6238 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6239
6240 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6241 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6242 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6243 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6244 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6245 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6246 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6247 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6248 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6249 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6250
6251 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6252
6253 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6254 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6255
6256 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6257 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6258
6259
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006260option http-buffer-request
6261no option http-buffer-request
6262 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6264 yes | yes | yes | yes
6265 Arguments : none
6266
6267 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6268 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6269 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6270 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6271 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6272 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006273 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6274 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6275 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6276 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006277
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006278 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006279
6280
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006281option http-ignore-probes
6282no option http-ignore-probes
6283 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6285 yes | yes | yes | no
6286 Arguments : none
6287
6288 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6289 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6290 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6291 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6292 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6293 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6294 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6295 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6296 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006297 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6298 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006299 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6300
6301 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6302 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6303 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6304 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6305 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6306 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6307 are often the only way to detect them.
6308
6309 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6310 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6311
6312 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6313
6314
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006315option http-keep-alive
6316no option http-keep-alive
6317 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6319 yes | yes | yes | yes
6320 Arguments : none
6321
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006322 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6323 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006324 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6325 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006326 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6327 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6328 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006329
6330 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6331 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006332 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6333 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6334 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6335 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6336 situations where this option may be useful :
6337
6338 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006339 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006340
6341 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6342 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6343
6344 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6345 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6346 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6347 request.
6348
6349 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6350 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006351 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6352 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6353 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006354
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006355 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6356 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6357 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6358 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6359 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6360 not set.
6361
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006362 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6363 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6364 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006365
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006366 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006367 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006368 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006369
6370
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006371option http-no-delay
6372no option http-no-delay
6373 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6375 yes | yes | yes | yes
6376 Arguments : none
6377
6378 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6379 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6380 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6381 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6382 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6383 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6384 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6385 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6386 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6387 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6388 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6389 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6390 affected.
6391
6392 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6393 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6394 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6395 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6396 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6397 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6398 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6399 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6400 latency environments.
6401
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006402 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6403
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006404
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006405option http-pretend-keepalive
6406no option http-pretend-keepalive
6407 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006409 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006410 Arguments : none
6411
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006412 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006413 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6414 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6415 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6416 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6417 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6418 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6419 consider the response complete.
6420
6421 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6422 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6423 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6424 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006425 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006426 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6427
6428 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6429 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6430 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6431 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6432 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6433 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6434 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6435
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006436 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6437 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6438 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6439 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6440 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6441 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006442
6443 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6444 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6445
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006446 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006447 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006448
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006449
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006450option http-server-close
6451no option http-server-close
6452 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6454 yes | yes | yes | yes
6455 Arguments : none
6456
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006457 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6458 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6459 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6460 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006461 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6462 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6463 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6464 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6465 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6466 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6467 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6468 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6469 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6470 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6471 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006472
6473 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6474 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6475 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6476 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006477 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6478 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006479
6480 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6481 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006482 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6483 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6484 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006485
6486 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6487 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6488
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006489 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6490 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006491
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006492option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006493no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006494 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6496 yes | yes | yes | no
6497 Arguments : none
6498
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006499 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006500 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6501 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6502 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6503 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6504 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6505 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6506
6507 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6508 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006509 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6510 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6511 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006512
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006513 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6514 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6515 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6516 front of an existing proxy.
6517
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006518 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6519
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006520 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006521
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006522option httpchk
6523option httpchk <uri>
6524option httpchk <method> <uri>
6525option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6526 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6528 yes | no | yes | yes
6529 Arguments :
6530 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6531 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6532 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6533 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6534 ones.
6535
6536 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6537 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6538 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6539
6540 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6541 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6542 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6543 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6544 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6545
6546 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6547 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6548 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6549 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6550 the lack of any response.
6551
6552 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6553
6554 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6555 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6556 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6557
6558 Examples :
6559 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6560 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6561 backend https_relay
6562 mode tcp
6563 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6564 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6565
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006566 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6567 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6568 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006569
6570
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006571option httpclose
6572no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006573 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6575 yes | yes | yes | yes
6576 Arguments : none
6577
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006578 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6579 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6580 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6581 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006582 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006583
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006584 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6585 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006586 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006587 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6588 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006589
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006590 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6591 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6592 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006593
6594 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6595 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006596 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6597 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6598 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006599
6600 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6601 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6602
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006603 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006604
6605
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006606option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006607 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006609 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006610 Arguments :
6611 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6612 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6613 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006614 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006615 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006616
6617 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6618 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6619 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6620 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6621 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6622 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6623 ports.
6624
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006625 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6626 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006627
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006628 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006630 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006631
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006632
6633option http_proxy
6634no option http_proxy
6635 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6637 yes | yes | yes | yes
6638 Arguments : none
6639
6640 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6641 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6642 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6643 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6644 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6645
6646 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6647 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006648 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6649 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006650
6651 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6652 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6653
6654 Example :
6655 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6656 backend direct_forward
6657 option httpclose
6658 option http_proxy
6659
6660 See also : "option httpclose"
6661
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006662
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006663option independent-streams
6664no option independent-streams
6665 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6667 yes | yes | yes | yes
6668 Arguments : none
6669
6670 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6671 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6672 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6673 receive data or not.
6674
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006675 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006676 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6677 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6678 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6679 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6680 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6681 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6682 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6683 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6684 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6685 socket buffers.
6686
6687 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6688 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6689 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6690 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6691 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6692
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006693 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006694
6695
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006696option ldap-check
6697 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6699 yes | no | yes | yes
6700 Arguments : none
6701
6702 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6703 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6704 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6705 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6706
6707 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6708 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6709
6710 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6711 configure it.
6712
6713 Example :
6714 option ldap-check
6715
6716 See also : "option httpchk"
6717
6718
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006719option external-check
6720 Use external processes for server health checks
6721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6722 yes | no | yes | yes
6723
6724 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6725 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6726 command".
6727
6728 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6729
6730 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6731
6732
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006733option log-health-checks
6734no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006735 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6737 yes | no | yes | yes
6738 Arguments : none
6739
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006740 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6741 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6742 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006743
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006744 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6745 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6746 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6747 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6748 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6749
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006750 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006751 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006752
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006753 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6754 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6755 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006756
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006757
6758option log-separate-errors
6759no option log-separate-errors
6760 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6762 yes | yes | yes | no
6763 Arguments : none
6764
6765 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6766 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6767 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6768 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6769 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6770 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6771 provides very important information.
6772
6773 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6774 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6775 error logs.
6776
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006777 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006778 logging.
6779
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006780
6781option logasap
6782no option logasap
6783 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6785 yes | yes | yes | no
6786 Arguments : none
6787
6788 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6789 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6790 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6791 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6792 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6793 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6794 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006795 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006796 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6797 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6798
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006799 Examples :
6800 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6801 mode http
6802 option httplog
6803 option logasap
6804 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6805
6806 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6807 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6808 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6809 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6810
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006811 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006812 logging.
6813
6814
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006815option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006816 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6818 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006819 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006820 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6821 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006822 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006823
6824 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6825 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006826 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006827 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6828 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6829 in the MySQL table, like this :
6830
6831 USE mysql;
6832 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6833 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6834
6835 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006836 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006837 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6838 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6839 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6840 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6841 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6842 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6843 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6844
6845 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6846 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006847
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006848 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006849
6850 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6851 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6852 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6853 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006854 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6855 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006856
6857 See also: "option httpchk"
6858
6859
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006860option nolinger
6861no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006862 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6864 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006865 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006866
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006867 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006868 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6869 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6870 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6871 connections.
6872
6873 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6874 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6875 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6876 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6877 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6878 this too.
6879
6880 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6881 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6882 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6883
6884 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6885 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6886 for servers.
6887
6888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6890
6891
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006892option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6893 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6895 yes | yes | yes | yes
6896 Arguments :
6897 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6898 matching <network>
6899 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6900 header name.
6901
6902 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6903 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6904 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6905 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6906 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6907 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6908 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6909 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6910 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6911 possible that the client has already brought one.
6912
6913 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6914 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6915 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6916 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6917 header and requires different one.
6918
6919 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6920 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6921 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6922 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6923 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6924 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6925 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6926
6927 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6928 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6929 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6930 both are defined.
6931
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006932 Examples :
6933 # Original Destination address
6934 frontend www
6935 mode http
6936 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6937
6938 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6939 backend www
6940 mode http
6941 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6942
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006943 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006944
6945
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006946option persist
6947no option persist
6948 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006951 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006952
6953 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6954 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6955 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6956 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6957 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6958 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6959 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6960 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6961 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6962 redirected to another valid server.
6963
6964 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6965 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6966
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006967 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006968
6969
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006970option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6971 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6973 yes | no | yes | yes
6974 Arguments :
6975 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6976 PostgreSQL server.
6977
6978 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6979 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6980 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6981 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6982
6983 See also: "option httpchk"
6984
6985
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006986option prefer-last-server
6987no option prefer-last-server
6988 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6990 yes | no | yes | yes
6991 Arguments : none
6992
6993 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6994 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6995 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6996 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6997 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6998 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6999 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7000 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7001 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007002 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7003 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007004 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7005 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7006 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007007 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7008 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7009 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007010
7011 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7012 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7013
7014 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7015
7016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007017option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007018option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007019no option redispatch
7020 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7022 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007023 Arguments :
7024 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7025 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7026 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007027 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007028 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007029 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007030 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7031 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7032 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7033
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007034
7035 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7036 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7037 be able to access the service anymore.
7038
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007039 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7040 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007041
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007042 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007043 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7044 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007045
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007046 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7047 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7048
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007049 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007050
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007051
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007052option redis-check
7053 Use redis health checks for server testing
7054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7055 yes | no | yes | yes
7056 Arguments : none
7057
7058 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7059 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7060 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7061 find the "+PONG" response message.
7062
7063 Example :
7064 option redis-check
7065
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007066 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007067
7068
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007069option smtpchk
7070option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7071 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7073 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007074 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007075 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007076 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007077 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7078
7079 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7080 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7081 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7082
7083 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7084 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7085 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7086 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7087 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7088 dead server.
7089
7090 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7091 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007092 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007093 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7094
7095 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7096 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7097 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7098 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007099 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007100
7101 Example :
7102 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7103
7104 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007107option socket-stats
7108no option socket-stats
7109
7110 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7112 yes | yes | yes | no
7113
7114 Arguments : none
7115
7116
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007117option splice-auto
7118no option splice-auto
7119 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7121 yes | yes | yes | yes
7122 Arguments : none
7123
7124 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7125 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007126 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007127 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007128 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007129 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7130 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7131 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7132 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7133
7134 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7135 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7136 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7137 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7138 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7139 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7140 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7141 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7142 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7143 keyword.
7144
7145 Example :
7146 option splice-auto
7147
7148 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7149 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7150
7151 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7152 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7153
7154
7155option splice-request
7156no option splice-request
7157 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7159 yes | yes | yes | yes
7160 Arguments : none
7161
7162 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007163 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007164 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7165 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7166 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7167 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7168
7169 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7170
7171 Example :
7172 option splice-request
7173
7174 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7175 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7176
7177 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7178 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7179
7180
7181option splice-response
7182no option splice-response
7183 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7185 yes | yes | yes | yes
7186 Arguments : none
7187
7188 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007189 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007190 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7191 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7192 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7193 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7194
7195 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7196
7197 Example :
7198 option splice-response
7199
7200 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7201 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7202
7203 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7204 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7205
7206
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007207option spop-check
7208 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7210 no | no | no | yes
7211 Arguments : none
7212
7213 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7214 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7215 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7216 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7217
7218 Example :
7219 option spop-check
7220
7221 See also : "option httpchk"
7222
7223
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007224option srvtcpka
7225no option srvtcpka
7226 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7228 yes | no | yes | yes
7229 Arguments : none
7230
7231 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7232 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007233 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007234 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7235
7236 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7237 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7238 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7239 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7240
7241 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7242 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7243 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7244 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7245 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7246
7247 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7248
7249 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7250 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7251 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7252
7253 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7254 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7255
7256 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7257
7258
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007259option ssl-hello-chk
7260 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7262 yes | no | yes | yes
7263 Arguments : none
7264
7265 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7266 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7267 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7268 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7269 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7270 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7271 hello message.
7272
7273 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7274 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7275 messages, which is appreciable.
7276
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007277 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7278 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7279 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007280
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007281 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7282
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007283
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007284option tcp-check
7285 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7286 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7287 yes | no | yes | yes
7288
7289 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7290 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7291
7292 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7293 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7294 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7295
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007296 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007297 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7298 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7299 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7300 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7301 only.
7302
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007303 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007304 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7305 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7306 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7307 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7308
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007309 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007310 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7311 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007312 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007313 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7314 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7315 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7316 the respective protocols.
7317 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007318 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007319
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007320 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7321 script.
7322
7323 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7324 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7325 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7326 The "comment" is of course optional.
7327
7328
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007329 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007330 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007331 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007332 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007333
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007334 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007335 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007336 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007337
7338 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7339 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007340 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007341 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007342 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007343 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007344 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007345 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007346 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7347 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007348 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007349 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7350 tcp-check expect string +OK
7351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007352 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007353 (send many headers before analyzing)
7354 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007355 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007356 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7357 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7358 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7359 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007360 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007361
7362
7363 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7364
7365
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007366option tcp-smart-accept
7367no option tcp-smart-accept
7368 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7370 yes | yes | yes | no
7371 Arguments : none
7372
7373 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7374 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7375 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7376 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7377 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7378 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7379
7380 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7381 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7382 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7383 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7384
7385 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7386 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7387 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007388 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007389
7390 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7391 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7392 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7393
7394 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7395 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7396 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7397
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007398 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7399
7400
7401option tcp-smart-connect
7402no option tcp-smart-connect
7403 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7405 yes | no | yes | yes
7406 Arguments : none
7407
7408 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7409 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7410 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7411 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7412 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7413
7414 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7415 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7416 complex.
7417
7418 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7419 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7420 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7421
7422 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7423 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7424
7425 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7426
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007427
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007428option tcpka
7429 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7431 yes | yes | yes | yes
7432 Arguments : none
7433
7434 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7435 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007436 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007437 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7438
7439 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7440 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7441 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7442 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7443
7444 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7445 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7446 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7447 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7448 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7449
7450 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7451
7452 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7453 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7454 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7455 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7456 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7457 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7458 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7459 backends.
7460
7461 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7462
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007463
7464option tcplog
7465 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007467 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007468 Arguments : none
7469
7470 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7471 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7472 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7473 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7474 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7475 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7476 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7477 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7478
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007479 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007481 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007482
7483
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007484option transparent
7485no option transparent
7486 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007488 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007489 Arguments : none
7490
7491 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7492 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7493 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7494 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7495 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7496 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7497 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7498 appropriate server.
7499
7500 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7501 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7502
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007503 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007504 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007505
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007506
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007507external-check command <command>
7508 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7510 yes | no | yes | yes
7511
7512 Arguments :
7513 <command> is the external command to run
7514
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007515 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7516
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007517 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007518
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007519 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7520 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7521 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7522 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7523 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7524 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007525
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007526 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7527
7528 Environment variables :
7529 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7530 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7531
7532 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7533
7534 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7535
7536 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7537 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7538 for a UNIX socket).
7539
7540 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7541
7542 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7543
7544 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7545
7546 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7547
7548 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7549
7550 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7551 socket).
7552
7553 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7554 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7555
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007556 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7557
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007558 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7559 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7560 failed.
7561
7562 Example :
7563 external-check command /bin/true
7564
7565 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7566
7567
7568external-check path <path>
7569 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7571 yes | no | yes | yes
7572
7573 Arguments :
7574 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7575
7576 The default path is "".
7577
7578 Example :
7579 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7580
7581 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7582 "external-check command"
7583
7584
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007585persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007586persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007587 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7589 yes | no | yes | yes
7590 Arguments :
7591 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007592 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7593 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007594
7595 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7596 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007597 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007598 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7599 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7600 forwarded to this server.
7601
7602 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7603 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7604 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007605 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007606 a single "listen" section.
7607
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007608 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7609 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7610 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7611
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007612 Example :
7613 listen tse-farm
7614 bind :3389
7615 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7616 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7617 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7618 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7619 persist rdp-cookie
7620 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007621 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007622 balance rdp-cookie
7623 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7624 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7625
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007626 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7627 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007628
7629
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007630rate-limit sessions <rate>
7631 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7633 yes | yes | yes | no
7634 Arguments :
7635 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7636 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7637
7638 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7639 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7640 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7641 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7642 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7643 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7644
7645 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7646 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7647 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7648 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7649
7650 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7651 listen smtp
7652 mode tcp
7653 bind :25
7654 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007655 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007656
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007657 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7658 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7659 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007660
7661 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7662
7663
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007664redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7665redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7666redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007667 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7669 no | yes | yes | yes
7670
7671 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007672 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007673
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007674 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007675 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007676 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7677 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7678 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007679
7680 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7681 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7682 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7683 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7684 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007685 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7686 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7687 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7688 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007689
7690 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7691 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7692 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7693 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7694 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7695 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007696 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007697 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007698 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7699 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7700 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007701
7702 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007703 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7704 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7705 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007706 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007707 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7708 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7709 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7710 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007711
7712 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007713 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007714
7715 - "drop-query"
7716 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7717 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7718 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7719 with a location-type redirect.
7720
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007721 - "append-slash"
7722 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7723 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7724 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7725 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7726
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007727 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7728 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7729 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7730 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7731 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7732 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7733 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7734
7735 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7736 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7737 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7738 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7739 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7740 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7741 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007742
7743 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7744 acl clear dst_port 80
7745 acl secure dst_port 8080
7746 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007747 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007748 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007749 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7750
7751 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007752 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7753 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7754 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007755 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007756
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007757 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7758 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7759 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7760
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007761 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007762 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007763
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007764 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007765 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7766 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7767 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007769 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007770
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007771
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007772retries <value>
7773 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7774 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7775 yes | no | yes | yes
7776 Arguments :
7777 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7778 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7779 default value is 3.
7780
7781 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7782 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7783 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7784
7785 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007786 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7787 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007788
7789 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7790 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7791
7792 See also : "option redispatch"
7793
7794
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007795retry-on [list of keywords]
7796 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7797 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7798 yes | no | yes | yes
7799 Arguments :
7800 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7801 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7802 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7803 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7804
7805 none never retry
7806
7807 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7808 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7809
7810 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7811 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7812 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7813 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7814 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7815 processing the request.
7816
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007817 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7818 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
7819 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
7820 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
7821 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
7822 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
7823 overflow attack for example).
7824
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007825 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
7826 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
7827 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
7828 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
7829 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
7830 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
7831 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
7832 amplify denial of service attacks.
7833
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02007834 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
7835 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
7836 considered to be safe to retry.
7837
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007838 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
7839 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
7840 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
7841 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
7842
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02007843 all-retryable-errors
7844 retry request for any error that are considered
7845 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
7846 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
7847 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
7848
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007849 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
7850 not cumulative.
7851
7852 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
7853 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
7854 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
7855 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
7856
7857 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
7858 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
7859 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
7860 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
7861 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
7862 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
7863 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
7864 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
7865 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
7866 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
7867 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
7868 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
7869
7870 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
7871 should not use this directive.
7872
7873 The default is "conn-failure".
7874
7875 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
7876
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007877server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007878 Declare a server in a backend
7879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7880 no | no | yes | yes
7881 Arguments :
7882 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007883 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007884 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007885
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007886 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7887 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7888 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7889 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007890 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7891 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7892 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7893 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7894 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007895 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7896 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7897 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7898 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7899 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7900 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7901 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007902 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007903 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7904 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7905 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7906 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7907 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
7908 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007909 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7910 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007911 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7912 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007913
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007914 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007915 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7916 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7917 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7918 adding this value to the client's port.
7919
7920 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7921 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007922 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007923
7924 Examples :
7925 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7926 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007927 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007928 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7929 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7930 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007931
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007932 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7933 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7934 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7935 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7936 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7937
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007938 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7939 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007940
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007941server-state-file-name [<file>]
7942 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7943 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7944 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7945 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7946 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7947 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7948
7949 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7950 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7951
7952 global
7953 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7954
7955 backend bk
7956 load-server-state-from-file
7957
7958 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7959 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007960
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007961server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7962 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7963 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7965 no | no | yes | yes
7966
7967 Arguments:
7968 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7969
7970 <num | range>
7971 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7972 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7973 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7974 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7975
7976 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7977
7978 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7979
7980 <params*>
7981 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7982 keyword.
7983
7984 Examples:
7985 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7986 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7987 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7988
7989 # or
7990 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7991
7992 # would be equivalent to:
7993 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7994 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7995 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7996
7997
7998
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007999source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008000source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008001source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008002 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8004 yes | no | yes | yes
8005 Arguments :
8006 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8007 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008008
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008009 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008010 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8011 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8012 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8013 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8014 supported prefixes are :
8015 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8016 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8017 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008018 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008019 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8020 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008021
8022 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8023 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008024 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8025 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8026 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008027
8028 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8029 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8030 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8031 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8032 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8033 <addr>.
8034
8035 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8036 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8037 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8038 port.
8039
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008040 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8041 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8042 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8043 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008044 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008045 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8046 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8047 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8048 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8049 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8050 HTTP header.
8051
8052 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8053 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008054 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008055 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8056 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8057 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8058 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8059 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8060 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8061 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8062
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008063 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8064 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8065 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8066 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8067 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8068 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8069
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008070 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8071 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8072 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8073 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8074
8075 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8076 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8077 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8078 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8079 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8080 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8081
8082 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8083 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8084 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8085 there are two methods :
8086
8087 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8088 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8089 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8090 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8091 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8092 of the client ranges may be used.
8093
8094 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8095 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8096 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8097 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8098 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8099 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8100 same session.
8101
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008102 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8103 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8104 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008105 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008106
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008107 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8108
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008109 Examples :
8110 backend private
8111 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8112 source 192.168.1.200
8113
8114 backend transparent_ssl1
8115 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8116 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8117
8118 backend transparent_ssl2
8119 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8120 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8121 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8122
8123 backend transparent_ssl3
8124 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8125 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8126 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8127
8128 backend transparent_smtp
8129 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8130 # with Tproxy version 4.
8131 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8132
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008133 backend transparent_http
8134 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8135 # proxy.
8136 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008138 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008139 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8140
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008141
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008142stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8143 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008145 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008146
8147 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8148 matched.
8149
8150 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8151 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8152
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008153 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8154 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008155 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008156
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008157 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8158 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8159 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8160 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008161
8162 Example :
8163 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8164 backend stats_localhost
8165 stats enable
8166 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8167
8168 Example :
8169 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8170 backend stats_auth
8171 stats enable
8172 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8173 stats admin if TRUE
8174
8175 Example :
8176 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8177 userlist stats-auth
8178 group admin users admin
8179 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8180 group readonly users haproxy
8181 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8182
8183 backend stats_auth
8184 stats enable
8185 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8186 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8187 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8188 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8189
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008190 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8191 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8192 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008193
8194
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008195stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8196 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008198 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008199 Arguments :
8200 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8201
8202 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8203
8204 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8205 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8206 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8207 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8208 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8209 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8210
8211 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8212 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8213 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008214 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008215
8216 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8217 report using "stats scope".
8218
8219 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8220 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8221 unobvious parameters.
8222
8223 Example :
8224 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8225 backend public_www
8226 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8227 stats enable
8228 stats hide-version
8229 stats scope .
8230 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008231 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008232 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8233 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8234
8235 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8236 backend private_monitoring
8237 stats enable
8238 stats uri /admin?stats
8239 stats refresh 5s
8240
8241 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8242
8243
8244stats enable
8245 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008247 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008248 Arguments : none
8249
8250 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8251 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8252 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8253 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8254 - stats auth : no authentication
8255 - stats scope : no restriction
8256
8257 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8258 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8259 unobvious parameters.
8260
8261 Example :
8262 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8263 backend public_www
8264 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8265 stats enable
8266 stats hide-version
8267 stats scope .
8268 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008269 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008270 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8271 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8272
8273 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8274 backend private_monitoring
8275 stats enable
8276 stats uri /admin?stats
8277 stats refresh 5s
8278
8279 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8280
8281
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008282stats hide-version
8283 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008285 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008286 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008287
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008288 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8289 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8290 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8291 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8292 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8293 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008295 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8296 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8297 unobvious parameters.
8298
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008299 Example :
8300 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8301 backend public_www
8302 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008303 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008304 stats hide-version
8305 stats scope .
8306 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008307 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008308 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8309 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008310
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008311 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8312 backend private_monitoring
8313 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008314 stats uri /admin?stats
8315 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008316
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008317 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008318
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008319
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008320stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8321 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8322 Access control for statistics
8323
8324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8325 no | no | yes | yes
8326
8327 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8328 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8329 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8330 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8331 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8332 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8333
8334 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8335 instance.
8336
8337 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8338 about ACL usage.
8339
8340
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008341stats realm <realm>
8342 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008344 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008345 Arguments :
8346 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8347 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8348 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8349
8350 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8351 using a backslash ('\').
8352
8353 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8354 only related to authentication.
8355
8356 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8357 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8358 unobvious parameters.
8359
8360 Example :
8361 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8362 backend public_www
8363 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8364 stats enable
8365 stats hide-version
8366 stats scope .
8367 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008368 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008369 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8370 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8371
8372 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8373 backend private_monitoring
8374 stats enable
8375 stats uri /admin?stats
8376 stats refresh 5s
8377
8378 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8379
8380
8381stats refresh <delay>
8382 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008384 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008385 Arguments :
8386 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8387 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8388 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8389 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8390 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8391 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8392
8393 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8394 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8395 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8396 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8397
8398 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8399 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8400 unobvious parameters.
8401
8402 Example :
8403 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8404 backend public_www
8405 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8406 stats enable
8407 stats hide-version
8408 stats scope .
8409 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008410 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008411 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8412 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8413
8414 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8415 backend private_monitoring
8416 stats enable
8417 stats uri /admin?stats
8418 stats refresh 5s
8419
8420 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8421
8422
8423stats scope { <name> | "." }
8424 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008426 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008427 Arguments :
8428 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8429 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8430 section in which the statement appears.
8431
8432 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8433 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8434 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8435 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8436 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8437 exists.
8438
8439 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8440 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8441 unobvious parameters.
8442
8443 Example :
8444 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8445 backend public_www
8446 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8447 stats enable
8448 stats hide-version
8449 stats scope .
8450 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008451 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008452 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8453 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8454
8455 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8456 backend private_monitoring
8457 stats enable
8458 stats uri /admin?stats
8459 stats refresh 5s
8460
8461 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8462
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008463
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008464stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008465 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008467 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008468
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008469 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008470 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8471
8472 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8473 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8474
8475 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8476 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008477 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008478
8479 Example :
8480 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8481 backend private_monitoring
8482 stats enable
8483 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8484 stats uri /admin?stats
8485 stats refresh 5s
8486
8487 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8488 global section.
8489
8490
8491stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008492 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8494 yes | yes | yes | yes
8495 Arguments : none
8496
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008497 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008498 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8499 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8500 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8501 - IP (socket, server)
8502 - cookie (backend, server)
8503
8504 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8505 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008506 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008507
8508 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8509
8510
8511stats show-node [ <name> ]
8512 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008514 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008515 Arguments:
8516 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8517 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8518
8519 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8520 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008521 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008522
8523 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8524 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8525 unobvious parameters.
8526
8527 Example:
8528 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8529 backend private_monitoring
8530 stats enable
8531 stats show-node Europe-1
8532 stats uri /admin?stats
8533 stats refresh 5s
8534
8535 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8536 section.
8537
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008538
8539stats uri <prefix>
8540 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008542 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008543 Arguments :
8544 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8545 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8546 query string.
8547
8548 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8549 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8550 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8551 possible to reach it in the application.
8552
8553 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008554 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008555 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8556 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8557 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8558 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8559
8560 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8561 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8562 an address or a port to statistics only.
8563
8564 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8565 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8566 unobvious parameters.
8567
8568 Example :
8569 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8570 backend public_www
8571 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8572 stats enable
8573 stats hide-version
8574 stats scope .
8575 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008576 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008577 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8578 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8579
8580 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8581 backend private_monitoring
8582 stats enable
8583 stats uri /admin?stats
8584 stats refresh 5s
8585
8586 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8587
8588
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008589stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8590 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008592 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008593
8594 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008595 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008596 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008597 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008598 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8599
8600 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8601 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8602 the "stick-table" statement.
8603
8604 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8605 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8606 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8607 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8608 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8609
8610 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8611 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8612 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8613 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8614 transformation rules.
8615
8616 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8617 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8618 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8619 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8620 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8621 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8622 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8623
8624 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8625 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8626 ACL based conditions.
8627
8628 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8629 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8630 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8631 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8632
8633 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8634 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8635 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8636 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8637
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008638 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8639 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008640 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008641
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008642 Example :
8643 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8644 # last 30 minutes
8645 backend pop
8646 mode tcp
8647 balance roundrobin
8648 stick store-request src
8649 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8650 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8651 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8652
8653 backend smtp
8654 mode tcp
8655 balance roundrobin
8656 stick match src table pop
8657 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8658 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8659
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008660 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008661 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008662
8663
8664stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8665 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8667 no | no | yes | yes
8668
8669 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8670 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8671 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8672 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8673
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008674 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8675 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008676 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008677
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008678 Examples :
8679 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008680 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008681
8682 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8683 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8684 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8685
8686
8687 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8688 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8689 backend http
8690 mode http
8691 balance roundrobin
8692 stick on src table https
8693 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8694 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8695 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8696
8697 backend https
8698 mode tcp
8699 balance roundrobin
8700 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8701 stick on src
8702 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8703 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8704
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008705 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008706
8707
8708stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8709 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8711 no | no | yes | yes
8712
8713 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008714 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008715 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008716 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008717 server is selected.
8718
8719 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8720 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8721 the "stick-table" statement.
8722
8723 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8724 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8725 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8726 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8727 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8728 address.
8729
8730 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8731 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8732 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8733 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8734 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8735 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8736 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8737 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8738 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8739 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8740
8741 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8742 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8743 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8744 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8745 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8746 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8747 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8748
8749 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8750 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8751 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8752 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8753
8754 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8755 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8756 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8757 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8758 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8759 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008760 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8761 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8762 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8763 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8764 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8765 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008766
8767 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8768 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8769 the request.
8770
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008771 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8772 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008773 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008774
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008775 Example :
8776 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8777 # last 30 minutes
8778 backend pop
8779 mode tcp
8780 balance roundrobin
8781 stick store-request src
8782 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8783 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8784 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8785
8786 backend smtp
8787 mode tcp
8788 balance roundrobin
8789 stick match src table pop
8790 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8791 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8792
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008793 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008794 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008795
8796
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008797stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008798 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8799 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008800 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008802 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008803
8804 Arguments :
8805 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8806 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8807 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8808 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8809
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008810 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8811 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8812 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8813 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8814
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008815 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8816 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8817 instance.
8818
8819 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8820 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8821 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8822 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8823 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8824 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008825 to 32 characters.
8826
8827 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8828 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8829 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008830 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008831 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8832 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008833
8834 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008835 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8836 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008837 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8838 increase.
8839
8840 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008841 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8842 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8843 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008844
8845 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8846 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8847 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8848 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008849 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008850 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8851 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8852 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8853 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8854 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8855 parameter (see below).
8856
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008857 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8858 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8859 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8860 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8861 soft restart.
8862
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008863 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8864 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008865
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008866 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8867 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8868 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8869 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008870 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008871 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008872 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8873 if not expiration delay is specified.
8874
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008875 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8876 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8877 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8878 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008879 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8880 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8881 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8882 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8883 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8884 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8885 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8886 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8887 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8888 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8889 types and their arguments.
8890
8891 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8892 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8893 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8894 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8895
8896 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8897 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8898 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008899 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008900
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008901 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8902 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8903 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008904 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008905 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008906 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008907
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008908 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8909 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8910 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8911 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
8912
8913 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
8914 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8915 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8916 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8917 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8918 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
8919
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008920 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8921 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8922 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8923 they were received.
8924
8925 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8926 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8927 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8928 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8929 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8930
8931 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8932 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8933 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8934 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8935 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8936
8937 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8938 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8939 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8940
8941 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8942 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8943 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8944 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8945 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8946
8947 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8948 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8949 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8950 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8951 the client side.
8952
8953 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8954 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8955 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8956 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8957 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8958 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8959 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8960
8961 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8962 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8963 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8964 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8965 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8966 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008967 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008968
8969 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8970 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8971 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8972 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8973 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8974 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8975
8976 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008977 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008978 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8979 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8980
8981 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8982 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8983 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8984 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8985 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8986 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8987 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8988 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8989 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8990 recommended for better fairness.
8991
8992 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008993 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008994 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8995 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8996
8997 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8998 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8999 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9000 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9001 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9002 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9003 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9004 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9005 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9006 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009007
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009008 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9009 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009010 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9011 reference it.
9012
9013 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9014 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009015 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9016 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9017 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009018
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009019 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9020 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9021 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9022 something that can be ignored.
9023
9024 Example:
9025 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9026 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9027 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9028 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9029
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009030 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009031 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009032
9033
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009034stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009035 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9037 no | no | yes | yes
9038
9039 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009040 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009041 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009042 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009043 server is selected.
9044
9045 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9046 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9047 the "stick-table" statement.
9048
9049 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9050 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9051 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9052 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9053
9054 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9055 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9056 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9057 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9058 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9059 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009060 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009061 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9062 rules.
9063
9064 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9065 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9066 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9067 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9068 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9069 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9070 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9071
9072 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9073 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9074 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9075 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9076
9077 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9078 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9079 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9080 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9081 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9082 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009083 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9084 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9085 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9086 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9087 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9088 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9089 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9090 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9091 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009092
9093 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9094
9095 Example :
9096 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9097 backend https
9098 mode tcp
9099 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009100 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009101 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009102
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009103 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9104 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9105
9106 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9107 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9108 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9109
9110 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9111 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009112
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009113 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9114 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9115 # at offset 44.
9116
9117 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9118 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9119
9120 # Learn on response if server hello.
9121 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009122
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009123 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9124 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9125
9126 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9127 extraction.
9128
9129
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009130tcp-check connect [params*]
9131 Opens a new connection
9132 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9133 no | no | yes | yes
9134
9135 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9136 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9137 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9138
9139 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9140 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9141 of the sequence.
9142
9143 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9144 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9145 do.
9146
9147 Parameters :
9148 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9149 use the TCP connection.
9150
9151 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9152 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9153 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9154
9155 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9156
9157 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9158
9159 Examples:
9160 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9161 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9162 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9163 option tcp-check
9164 tcp-check connect
9165 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9166 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9167 tcp-check send \r\n
9168 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9169 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9170 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9171 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9172 tcp-check send \r\n
9173 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9174 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9175
9176 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9177 option tcp-check
9178 tcp-check connect port 110
9179 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9180 tcp-check connect port 143
9181 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9182 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9183
9184 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9185
9186
9187tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009188 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009189 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9190 no | no | yes | yes
9191
9192 Arguments :
9193 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9194 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9195 binary.
9196 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9197 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9198 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9199
9200 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9201 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9202 with the usual backslash ('\').
9203 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009204 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009205 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9206 used upper or lower case.
9207
9208
9209 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9210
9211 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9212 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9213 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9214 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9215 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9216 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9217 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9218 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9219
9220 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9221 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9222 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9223 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9224 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9225 expression.
9226
9227 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9228 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9229 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9230 this exact hexadecimal string.
9231 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9232
9233 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9234 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9235 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9236 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9237 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9238 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9239 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9240 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9241 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9242 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9243 the null character.
9244
9245 Examples :
9246 # perform a POP check
9247 option tcp-check
9248 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9249
9250 # perform an IMAP check
9251 option tcp-check
9252 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9253
9254 # look for the redis master server
9255 option tcp-check
9256 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009257 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009258 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9259 tcp-check expect string role:master
9260 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9261 tcp-check expect string +OK
9262
9263
9264 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9265 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9266
9267
9268tcp-check send <data>
9269 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9271 no | no | yes | yes
9272
9273 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9274 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9275
9276 Examples :
9277 # look for the redis master server
9278 option tcp-check
9279 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9280 tcp-check expect string role:master
9281
9282 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9283 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9284
9285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009286tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9287 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009288 tcp health check
9289 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9290 no | no | yes | yes
9291
9292 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9293 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009294 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009295 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9296 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9297 hexadecimal string.
9298 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9299
9300 Examples :
9301 # redis check in binary
9302 option tcp-check
9303 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9304 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9305
9306
9307 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9308 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9309
9310
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009311tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9312 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9314 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009315 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009316 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9317 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009318
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009319 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009320
9321 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9322 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009323 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9324 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9325 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9326 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9327 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9328 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009329
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009330 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9331 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9332 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9333 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009334
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009335 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009336 - accept :
9337 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9338 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9339 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009340
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009341 - reject :
9342 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9343 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9344 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9345 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9346 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9347 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9348 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9349 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9350 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9351 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9352 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009353 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009354
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009355 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9356 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9357 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9358 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9359 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9360 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9361 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9362 hosts.
9363
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009364 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9365 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9366 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9367 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9368 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9369 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9370 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9371 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9372
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009373 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9374 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9375 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9376 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9377 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9378 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9379 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9380 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9381 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009382 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9383 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009384
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009385 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009386 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009387 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9388 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9389 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009390 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009391 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9392 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9393 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9394 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9395 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9396 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9397 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9398 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009399
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009400 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009401 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009402 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009403 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009404 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9405 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9406 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009407
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009408 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9409 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9410 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9411 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009412
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009413 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9414 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9415 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9416 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9417 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009418 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9419 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9420 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9421 layer7 information is extracted.
9422
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009423 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9424 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9425 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9426 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9427 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009428
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009429 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9430 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9431 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9432 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9433
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009434 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9435 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9436 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9437 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9438
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009439 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9440 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9441 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9442 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9443 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009444
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009445 - set-src <expr> :
9446 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9447 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9448 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009449 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009450
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009451 Arguments:
9452 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9453 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009454
9455 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009456 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9457
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009458 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9459 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009460
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009461 - set-src-port <expr> :
9462 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9463 expression.
9464
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009465 Arguments:
9466 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9467 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009468
9469 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009470 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9471
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009472 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9473 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9474 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009475
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009476 - set-dst <expr> :
9477 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9478 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9479 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9480 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9481 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9482
9483 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9484 followed by some converters.
9485
9486 Example:
9487
9488 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9489 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9490
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009491 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9492 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9493
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009494 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9495 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9496 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9497 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9498
9499
9500 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9501 followed by some converters.
9502
9503 Example:
9504
9505 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9506
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009507 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9508 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9509 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9510
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009511 - "silent-drop" :
9512 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009513 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009514 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9515 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9516 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9517 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9518 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009519 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9520 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009521 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9522 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009523 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009524 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9525 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9526 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9527 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9528
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009529 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9530 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9531 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009532
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009533 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9534 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9535 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009536
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009537 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009538 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009539 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009540
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009541 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9542 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9543 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009544
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009545 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009546 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9547 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009548
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009549 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9550
9551 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9552
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009553 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9554
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009555 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009556
9557
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009558tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9559 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009561 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009562 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009563 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9564 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009565
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009566 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009567
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009568 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009569 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9570 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9571 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9572 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009573
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009574 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9575 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9576 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9577 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009578 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9579 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9580 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9581 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9582 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9583 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009584 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009585 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009586
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009587 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9588 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9589 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9590 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009591
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009592 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009593 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009594 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009595 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9596 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009597 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009598 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009599 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009600 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009601 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009602 - set-dst <expr>
9603 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009604 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009605 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009606 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009607 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009608 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009609
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009610 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9611 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009612 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9613 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009614
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009615 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9616 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9617 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9618 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9619 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9620 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009622 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009623 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9624 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009625
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009626 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009627 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9628 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9629 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9630 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009631 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9632 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9633 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009634
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009635 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009636 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9637 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9638 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009639
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009640 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9641 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9642
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009643 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009644 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9645 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009646
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009647 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9648 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009649 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009650 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9651 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009652 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009653 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009654 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009655 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9656 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009657 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009658 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9659 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009660
9661 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9662 followed by some converters.
9663
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009664 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9665 <var-name>.
9666
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009667 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9668 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9669 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9670 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9671 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9672
9673 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9674 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9675 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9676 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9677 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9678 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9679 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9680 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9681 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9682 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9683 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9684
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009685 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9686 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9687 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9688 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9689 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9690
9691 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9692
9693 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9694
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009695 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9696 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9697 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9698 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9699 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9700 evaluated.
9701
9702 Example:
9703 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9704
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009705 Example:
9706
9707 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009708 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009709
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009710 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009711 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9712 # and reject everything else.
9713 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9714 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009715 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009716 tcp-request content reject
9717
9718 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009719 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9720 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9721 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009722 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009723
9724 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9725 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9726 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009727 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009728 tcp-request content reject
9729
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009730 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009731 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009732 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009733 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009734 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9735 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009736
9737 Example:
9738 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9739 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009740 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009741
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009742 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009743 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009744
9745 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009746 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009747 # protecting all our sites
9748 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009749 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9750 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009751 ...
9752 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9753
9754 backend http_dynamic
9755 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009756 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009757 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009758 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009759 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009760 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009761 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009763 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009764
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009765 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9766 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009767
9768
9769tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9770 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009772 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009773 Arguments :
9774 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9775 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9776 as explained at the top of this document.
9777
9778 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9779 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9780 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9781 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9782 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9783
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009784 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9785 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9786 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9787 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9788
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009789 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9790 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009791 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009792 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009793 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9794 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9795 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9796 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009797
9798 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9799 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9800 it pass through unaffected.
9801
9802 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9803 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9804 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009805 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009806 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9807 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009808 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9809 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9810 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009811
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009812 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009813 "timeout client".
9814
9815
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009816tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9817 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9819 no | no | yes | yes
9820 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009821 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9822 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009823
9824 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9825
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009826 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009827 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9828 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009829 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9830 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009831
9832 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9833
9834 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9835 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9836 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9837 inserted.
9838
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009839 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009840 - accept :
9841 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9842 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9843 the rules evaluation.
9844
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009845 - close :
9846 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9847 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9848 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9849 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9850 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9851 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009852 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009853 protocols.
9854
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009855 - reject :
9856 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9857 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009858 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009859
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009860 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9861 Sets a variable.
9862
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009863 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9864 Unsets a variable.
9865
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009866 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9867 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9868 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9869 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9870
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009871 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9872 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9873 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9874 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9875
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009876 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
9877 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9878 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9879 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9880 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009881
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009882 - "silent-drop" :
9883 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009884 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009885 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9886 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9887 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9888 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9889 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009890 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9891 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009892 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9893 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009894 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009895 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9896 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9897 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9898 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9899
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009900 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9901 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9902
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009903 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9904 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9905 for changing the default action to a reject.
9906
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009907 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9908 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9909 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9910 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009911 period.
9912
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009913 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9914 declared inline.
9915
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009916 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9917 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009918 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009919 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9920 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009921 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009922 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009923 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009924 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9925 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009926 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009927 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9928 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009929
9930 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9931 followed by some converters.
9932
9933 Example:
9934
9935 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9936
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009937 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9938 <var-name>.
9939
9940 Example:
9941
9942 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9943
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009944 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9945 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9946 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9947 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9948 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9949
9950 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9951
9952 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9953
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009954 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9955
9956 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9957
9958
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009959tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9960 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9962 no | yes | yes | no
9963 Arguments :
9964 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9965 below.
9966
9967 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9968
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009969 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009970 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9971 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9972 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9973 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9974 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9975 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9976 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009977 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009978 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9979 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9980 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9981 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9982 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9983 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9984 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9985 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9986 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9987 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9988 instead.
9989
9990 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9991 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9992 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9993 rules which may be inserted.
9994
9995 Several types of actions are supported :
9996 - accept : the request is accepted
9997 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9998 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9999 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010000 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010001 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010002 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010003 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010004 - silent-drop
10005
10006 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10007 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10008 sections for a complete description.
10009
10010 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10011 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10012 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10013
10014 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10015 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10016 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10017 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10018 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10019
10020 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10021 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10022
10023 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10024 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10025 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10026
10027 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10028 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10029 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10030
10031 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10032 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10033 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10034
10035 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10036 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10037 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10038
10039 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10040
10041 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10042
10043
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010044tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10045 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10047 no | no | yes | yes
10048 Arguments :
10049 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10050 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10051 as explained at the top of this document.
10052
10053 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10054
10055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010056timeout check <timeout>
10057 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10058 established.
10059
10060 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10061 yes | no | yes | yes
10062 Arguments:
10063 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10064 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10065 as explained at the top of this document.
10066
10067 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10068 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010069 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010070 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010071 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10072 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10073 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010074
10075 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10076 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10077
10078 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10079 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010080 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010081
10082 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10083 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10084 forget about it.
10085
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010086 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10087 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010088
10089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010090timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010091 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10093 yes | yes | yes | no
10094 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010095 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010096 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10097 as explained at the top of this document.
10098
10099 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10100 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10101 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010102 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10103 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10104 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10105 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010106 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10107 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10108 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010109 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010110 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010111 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10112 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010113 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10114 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010115
10116 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10117 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10118 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10119 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010120 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010121 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10122
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010123 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010124
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010125 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010126
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010127
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010128timeout client-fin <timeout>
10129 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10131 yes | yes | yes | no
10132 Arguments :
10133 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10134 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10135 as explained at the top of this document.
10136
10137 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10138 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10139 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10140 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10141 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10142 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10143 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010144 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10145 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10146 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010147
10148 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10149 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10150 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10151
10152 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10153
10154
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010155timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010156 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10158 yes | no | yes | yes
10159 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010160 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010161 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10162 as explained at the top of this document.
10163
10164 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010165 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010166 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010167 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010168 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10169 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010170
10171 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10172 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10173 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10174 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010175 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010176 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10177
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010178 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010179
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010180
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010181timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10182 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10184 yes | yes | yes | yes
10185 Arguments :
10186 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10187 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10188 as explained at the top of this document.
10189
10190 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10191 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10192 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10193 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10194 once the request has started to present itself.
10195
10196 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10197 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10198 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10199 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10200 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10201
10202 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10203 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10204 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10205 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10206
10207 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10208 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010209 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010210 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10211 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010212 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010213
10214 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10215 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10216 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10217 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10218
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010219 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10220 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010221 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10222
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010223 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10224
10225
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010226timeout http-request <timeout>
10227 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010229 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010230 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010231 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010232 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10233 as explained at the top of this document.
10234
10235 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10236 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10237 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10238 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10239 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10240 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10241 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010242 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10243 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10244 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10245 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010246 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010247 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10248 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010249
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010250 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10251 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10252 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10253 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10254 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010255 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010256
10257 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10258 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010259 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010260 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10261 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10262
10263 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010264 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10265 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10266 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010267
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010268 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010269 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010270
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010271
10272timeout queue <timeout>
10273 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10275 yes | no | yes | yes
10276 Arguments :
10277 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10278 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10279 as explained at the top of this document.
10280
10281 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10282 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10283 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10284 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10285 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10286
10287 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10288 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10289 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10290 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10291
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010292 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010293
10294
10295timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010296 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10297 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10298 yes | no | yes | yes
10299 Arguments :
10300 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10301 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10302 as explained at the top of this document.
10303
10304 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10305 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10306 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10307 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10308 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10309 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10310 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10311
10312 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10313 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10314 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10315 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10316 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010317 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010318 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010319 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10320 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010321 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10322 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010323
10324 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10325 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10326 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10327 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010328 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010329 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10330
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010331 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010332
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010333
10334timeout server-fin <timeout>
10335 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10337 yes | no | yes | yes
10338 Arguments :
10339 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10340 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10341 as explained at the top of this document.
10342
10343 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10344 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10345 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10346 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10347 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10348 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10349 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10350 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10351 situations, it should not be needed.
10352
10353 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10354 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10355 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10356
10357 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10358
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010359
10360timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010361 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10363 yes | yes | yes | yes
10364 Arguments :
10365 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10366 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10367 as explained at the top of this document.
10368
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010369 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10370 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10371 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010372
10373 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10374 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10375 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10376 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010377 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010378
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010379 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010380
10381
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010382timeout tunnel <timeout>
10383 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10385 yes | no | yes | yes
10386 Arguments :
10387 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10388 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10389 as explained at the top of this document.
10390
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010391 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010392 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10393 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10394 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010395 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10396 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010397 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10398 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10399 specified.
10400
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010401 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10402 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10403 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10404 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10405 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10406 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10407 state.
10408
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010409 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10410 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10411 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10412 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010413 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010414
10415 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10416 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10417 forget about it.
10418
10419 Example :
10420 defaults http
10421 option http-server-close
10422 timeout connect 5s
10423 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010424 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010425 timeout server 30s
10426 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10427
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010428 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010429
10430
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010431transparent (deprecated)
10432 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010434 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010435 Arguments : none
10436
10437 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10438 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10439 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10440 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10441 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10442 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10443 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10444 appropriate server.
10445
10446 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10447
10448 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10449 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10450
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010451 See also: "option transparent"
10452
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010453unique-id-format <string>
10454 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10456 yes | yes | yes | no
10457 Arguments :
10458 <string> is a log-format string.
10459
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010460 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10461 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10462 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10463 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010464
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010465 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10466 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10467 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10468 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10469 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10470 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10471 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10472 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010473
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010474 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10475 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010476
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010477 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010478
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010479 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010480
10481 will generate:
10482
10483 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10484
10485 See also: "unique-id-header"
10486
10487unique-id-header <name>
10488 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10490 yes | yes | yes | no
10491 Arguments :
10492 <name> is the name of the header.
10493
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010494 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10495 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010496
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010497 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010498
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010499 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010500 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10501
10502 will generate:
10503
10504 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10505
10506 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010507
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010508use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010509 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10511 no | yes | yes | no
10512 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010513 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10514 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010515
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010516 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10517 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010518
10519 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10520 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10521 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010522 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010523 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010524 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10525 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010526
10527 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10528 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10529 assign the backend.
10530
10531 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10532 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10533 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10534 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10535 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10536 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10537
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010538 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010539 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010540 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10541 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10542 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10543
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010544 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10545 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10546 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10547 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10548 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10549 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10550 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10551 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10552 cannot be forced from the request.
10553
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010554 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010555 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10556 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10557
10558 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10559 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010560
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010561use-fcgi-app <name>
10562 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10564 no | no | yes | yes
10565 Arguments :
10566 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10567
10568 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010569
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010570use-server <server> if <condition>
10571use-server <server> unless <condition>
10572 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10574 no | no | yes | yes
10575 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010576 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010577
10578 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10579
10580 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10581 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10582 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10583
10584 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10585 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10586 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10587 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10588 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10589 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10590 matches will assign the server.
10591
10592 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10593 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10594 with the next rules until one matches.
10595
10596 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10597 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10598 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10599 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10600
10601 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10602 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10603 stripped.
10604
10605 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10606 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10607 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10608 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10609
10610 Example :
10611 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10612 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10613 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10614 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10615 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10616 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010617 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010618 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10619 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10620
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010621 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010622
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010623
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100106245. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010625--------------------------
10626
10627The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10628depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10629settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10630written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10631described in this section.
10632
10633
106345.1. Bind options
10635-----------------
10636
10637The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10638as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10639no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10640parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10641while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10642provided immediately after the setting name.
10643
10644The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10645
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010646accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10647 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10648 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10649 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10650 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10651 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10652 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10653 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10654 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10655 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010656 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10657 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10658 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010659
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010660accept-proxy
10661 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010662 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10663 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010664 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10665 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10666 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10667 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010668 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010669 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10670 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010671 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10672 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010673
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010674allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010675 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010676 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010677 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010678 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10679 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010680
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010681alpn <protocols>
10682 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10683 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10684 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010685 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010686 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010687 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10688 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10689 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10690 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10691 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10692 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10693 preference, like below :
10694
10695 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010696
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010697backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010698 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010699 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10700
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010701curves <curves>
10702 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10703 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10704 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10705 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10706 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10707 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10708
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010709ecdhe <named curve>
10710 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010711 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10712 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010713
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010714ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010715 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10716 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10717 client's certificate.
10718
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010719ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10720 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10721 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10722 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10723 error is ignored.
10724
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010725ca-sign-file <cafile>
10726 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10727 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10728 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10729 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10730 'generate-certificates' for details.
10731
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010732ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010733 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10734 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10735 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10736 'generate-certificates' for details.
10737
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010738ciphers <ciphers>
10739 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10740 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010741 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010742 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010743 information and recommendations see e.g.
10744 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10745 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10746 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10747
10748ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10749 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10750 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10751 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10752 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010753 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10754 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010755
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010756crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10758 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10759 to verify client's certificate.
10760
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010761crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010762 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10763 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10764 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10765 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10766 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10767 file.
10768
10769 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10770 are loaded.
10771
10772 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010773 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010774 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10775 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10776 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10777 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010778 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10779 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010780 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010781
10782 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10783 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10784 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10785 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010786 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10787 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010788
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010789 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010790
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010791 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010792 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010793 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10794 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010795 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10796 clients).
10797
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010798 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10799 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10800 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10801 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10802 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10803 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10804 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10805 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10806 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10807 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10808 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10809 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10810 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10811
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010812 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10813 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10814 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10815 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10816 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10817
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010818 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10819 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10820 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10821 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010822
10823 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10824 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10825 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10826 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10827 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10828 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10829 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10830 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10831 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10832
10833 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10834
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010835 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010836 a cert bundle.
10837
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010838 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010839 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10840 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10841 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10842 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10843 provide multi-cert support.
10844
10845 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10846
10847 Filename | CN | SAN
10848 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10849 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010850 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010851 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10852 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10853
10854 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10855 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10856 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10857 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010858 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10859 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10860 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010861
10862 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10863 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10864
10865 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10866 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10867 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10868
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010869crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010871 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010872 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010873 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010874
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010875crt-list <file>
10876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010877 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10878 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010879
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010880 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10881
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010882 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10883 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010884 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010885 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010886
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010887 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10888 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10889 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10890 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10891 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10892 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10893 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10894 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010895
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010896 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010897 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010898 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10899 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10900 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010901
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010902 crt-list file example:
10903 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010904 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010905 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010906 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010907
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010908defer-accept
10909 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10910 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10911 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010912 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010913 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10914 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10915 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10916 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10917 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10918 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10919 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10920
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010921expose-fd listeners
10922 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10923 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010924 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10925 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010926 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010927
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010928force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010929 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010930 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010931 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010932 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010933
10934force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010935 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010936 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010937 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010938
10939force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010940 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010941 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010942 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010943
10944force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010945 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010946 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010947 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010948
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010949force-tlsv13
10950 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10951 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010952 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010953
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010954generate-certificates
10955 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10956 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10957 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10958 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10959 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10960 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10961 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10962 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10963 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10964 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10965 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10966
10967 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10968 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010969 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010970 certificate is used many times.
10971
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010972gid <gid>
10973 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10974 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10975 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10976 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10977 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10978
10979group <group>
10980 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10981 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10982 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10983 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10984 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10985
10986id <id>
10987 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10988 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10989 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10990 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10991
10992interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010993 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10994 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10995 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10996 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10997 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10998 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010010999 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11000 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11001 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11002 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11003 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11004 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011005
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011006level <level>
11007 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11008 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11009 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011010 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011011 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11012 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11013 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011014 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011015 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011016 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011017 all counters).
11018
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011019severity-output <format>
11020 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11021 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11022 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11023 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11024 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11025 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11026 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11027 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11028 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11029 rfc5424 convention.
11030
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011031maxconn <maxconn>
11032 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11033 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11034 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11035 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11036 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11037 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11038 eat all memory.
11039
11040mode <mode>
11041 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11042 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11043 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11044 UNIX sockets.
11045
11046mss <maxseg>
11047 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11048 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11049 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11050 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11051 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11052 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11053 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11054 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11055 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11056 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11057 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11058
11059name <name>
11060 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11061 page.
11062
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011063namespace <name>
11064 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11065 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11066 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11067 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11068
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011069nice <nice>
11070 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11071 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11072 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11073 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11074 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11075 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11076 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11077 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11078 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11079 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11080 one for an RDP socket.
11081
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011082no-ca-names
11083 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11084 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11085
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011086no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011087 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011088 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011089 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011090 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011091 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11092 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011093
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011094no-tls-tickets
11095 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11096 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11097 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011098 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11099 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011100
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011101no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011103 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011104 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011105 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011106 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11107 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011108
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011109no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011111 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011112 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011113 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011114 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11115 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011116
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011117no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011118 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011119 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011120 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011121 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011122 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11123 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011124
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011125no-tlsv13
11126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11127 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11128 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11129 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011130 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11131 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011132
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011133npn <protocols>
11134 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11135 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11136 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011137 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011138 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011139 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11140 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11141 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11142 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11143 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011144
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011145prefer-client-ciphers
11146 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11147 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11148 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011149 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11150 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11151 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011152
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011153process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011154 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011155 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011156 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011157 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11158 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11159 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11160 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011161 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011162 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11163 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11164 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11165 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11166 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011167
11168 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11169
11170 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11171 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11172 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11173 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11174 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11175 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11176 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11177 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011178
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011179proto <name>
11180 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11181 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11182 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11183 in haproxy -vv.
11184 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11185 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011186 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011187 h2" on the bind line.
11188
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011189ssl
11190 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011191 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011192 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11193 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011194 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11195 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011196
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011197ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11198 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11199 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11200 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11201
11202ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11203 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11204 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11205 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11206
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011207strict-sni
11208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11209 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11210 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11211 See the "crt" option for more information.
11212
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011213tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011214 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011215 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11216 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011217 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011218 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11219 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11220 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11221 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11222 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11223 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11224 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11225
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011226tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011227 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011228 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11229 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11230 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11231 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11232 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11233 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11234 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011235 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11236 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11237 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011238
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011239tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11240 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011241 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11242 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11243 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11244 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11245 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11246 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11247 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11248 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11249 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11250 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011251 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11252 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11253
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011254transparent
11255 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11256 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11257 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11258 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11259 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11260 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11261 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11262 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11263 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11264 so check for support with your vendor.
11265
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011266v4v6
11267 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11268 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11269 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11270 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011271 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011272
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011273v6only
11274 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11275 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11276 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011277 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11278 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011279
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011280uid <uid>
11281 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11282 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11283 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11284 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11285 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11286
11287user <user>
11288 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11289 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11290 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11291 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11292 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11293
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011294verify [none|optional|required]
11295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11296 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11297 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11298 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11299 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011300 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11301 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11302 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11303 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011304
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200113055.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011306------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011308The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11309which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11310arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11311settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11312after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11313Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11314address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011316 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011317 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011318
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011319Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11320keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011322The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011323
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011324addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011325 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011326 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11327 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11328 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11329 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11330 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011331
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011332agent-check
11333 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011334 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011335 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11336 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11337 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011338
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011339 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011340 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011341 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11342 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11343 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011345 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11346 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11347 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11348 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11349 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011350
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011351 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011352 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011353
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011354 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11355 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11356 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011357
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011358 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11359 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11360 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011361
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011362 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11363 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11364 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11365 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11366 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011367 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011368 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011369
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011370 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11371 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011372
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011373 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11374 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11375 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11376 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11377 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11378 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11379 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11380 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11381 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011382
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011383 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11384 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011385 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11386 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11387 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011388 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011389
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011390 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011391 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011392
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011393agent-send <string>
11394 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11395 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11396 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11397 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11398 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11399
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011400agent-inter <delay>
11401 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11402 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11403
11404 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11405 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11406 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11407 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11408 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11409 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11410 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11411 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11412 of backends use the same servers.
11413
11414 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11415
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011416agent-addr <addr>
11417 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11418
11419 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11420 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11421 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11422 hostname, it will be resolved.
11423
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011424agent-port <port>
11425 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11426
11427 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11428
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011429allow-0rtt
11430 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011431 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11432 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011433
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011434alpn <protocols>
11435 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11436 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11437 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011438 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011439 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11440 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11441 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11442 now obsolete NPN extension.
11443 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11444 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11445
11446 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011448backup
11449 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11450 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11451 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11452 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011453 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11454 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011455
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011456ca-file <cafile>
11457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11458 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11459 server's certificate.
11460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011461check
11462 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011463 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11464 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11465 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11466 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11467 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11468 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11469 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011470 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11471 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011472 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11473 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011474
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011475check-send-proxy
11476 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11477 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11478 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11479 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11480 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11481 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11482 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11483
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011484check-alpn <protocols>
11485 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11486 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11487 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11488
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011489check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011490 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011491 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11492 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011493
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011494check-ssl
11495 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11496 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11497 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11498 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011499 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011500 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11501 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011502 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011503 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11504 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011505
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011506check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011507 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011508 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11509 for normal traffic.
11510
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011511ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11513 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11514 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011515 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11516 information and recommendations see e.g.
11517 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11518 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11519 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011520
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011521ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11522 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11523 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11524 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11525 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011526 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11527 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11528 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011530cookie <value>
11531 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11532 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11533 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11534 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11535 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11536 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11537 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11538
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011539crl-file <crlfile>
11540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11541 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11542 to verify server's certificate.
11543
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011544crt <cert>
11545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11546 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11547 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11548 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11549 certificate request.
11550
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011551disabled
11552 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11553 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11554 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11555 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11556 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011557 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011558
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011559enabled
11560 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11561 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11562 default value.
11563 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11564 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011566error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011567 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11568 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11569 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011570
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011571 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011573fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011574 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11575 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11576 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11577
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011578force-sslv3
11579 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11580 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011581 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011582 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011583
11584force-tlsv10
11585 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011586 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011587 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011588
11589force-tlsv11
11590 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011591 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011592 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011593
11594force-tlsv12
11595 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011596 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011597 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011598
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011599force-tlsv13
11600 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11601 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011602 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011604id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011605 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11606 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11607 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011608
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011609init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11610 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11611 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011612 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011613 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11614 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11615 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11616 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11617 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11618 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11619 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11620 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11621 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011622 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011623 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11624 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11625 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11626 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11627 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11628 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011629 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011630
11631 Example:
11632 defaults
11633 # never fail on address resolution
11634 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011636inter <delay>
11637fastinter <delay>
11638downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011639 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11640 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11641 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11642 between checks depending on the server state :
11643
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011644 Server state | Interval used
11645 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11646 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11647 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11648 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11649 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11650 or yet unchecked. |
11651 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11652 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11653 | "inter" otherwise.
11654 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011656 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11657 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11658 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11659 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011660 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11661 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11662 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11663 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11664 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011666maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011667 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11668 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011669 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
11670 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011671 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11672 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11673 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11674 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11675
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011676 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
11677 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
11678 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
11679 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
11680 than 50 concurrent requests.
11681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011682maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011683 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11684 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11685 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11686 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11687 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11688 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11689 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11690
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011691max-reuse <count>
11692 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11693 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11694 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11695 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11696 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11697 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11698 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11699 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11700
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011701minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011702 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11703 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11704 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11705 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11706 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11707 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011708 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011709 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011710
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011711namespace <name>
11712 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11713 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11714 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11715 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11716
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011717no-agent-check
11718 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11719 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11720 default value.
11721 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11722 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11723
11724no-backup
11725 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11726 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11727 default value.
11728 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11729 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11730
11731no-check
11732 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11733 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11734 default value.
11735 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11736 "default-server" "check" setting.
11737
11738no-check-ssl
11739 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11740 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11741 default value.
11742 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11743 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11744
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011745no-send-proxy
11746 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11747 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11748 default value.
11749 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11750 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11751
11752no-send-proxy-v2
11753 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11754 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11755 default value.
11756 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11757 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11758
11759no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11760 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11761 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11762 default value.
11763 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11764 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11765
11766no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11767 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11768 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11769 default value.
11770 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11771 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11772
11773no-ssl
11774 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11775 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11776 default value.
11777 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11778 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11779
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011780no-ssl-reuse
11781 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11782 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11783 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11784 and for paranoid users.
11785
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011786no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011787 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11788 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011789 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011790
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011791 Supported in default-server: No
11792
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011793no-tls-tickets
11794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11795 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11796 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011797 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11798 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011799 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011800
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011801no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011802 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011803 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11804 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011805 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11806 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011807 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011808
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011809 Supported in default-server: No
11810
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011811no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011812 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011813 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11814 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011815 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11816 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011817 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011818
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011819 Supported in default-server: No
11820
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011821no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011822 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011823 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11824 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011825 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11826 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011827 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011828
11829 Supported in default-server: No
11830
11831no-tlsv13
11832 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11833 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11834 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11835 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11836 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011837 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011838
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011839 Supported in default-server: No
11840
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011841no-verifyhost
11842 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11843 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11844 default value.
11845 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11846 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011847
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020011848no-tfo
11849 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
11850 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11851 default value.
11852 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11853 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
11854
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011855non-stick
11856 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11857 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11858 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11859
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011860npn <protocols>
11861 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11862 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11863 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011864 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011865 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11866 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11867 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11868
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011869observe <mode>
11870 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11871 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11872 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11873 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11874 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11875 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011876 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011877
11878 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011880on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011881 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11882 Currently, four modes are available:
11883 - fastinter: force fastinter
11884 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11885 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11886 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11887 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11888
11889 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11890
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011891on-marked-down <action>
11892 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11893 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011894 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11895 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11896 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11897 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11898 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11899 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11900 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11901 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011902
11903 Actions are disabled by default
11904
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011905on-marked-up <action>
11906 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11907 Currently one action is available:
11908 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11909 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11910 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11911 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011912 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11913 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011914 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11915 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11916
11917 Actions are disabled by default
11918
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010011919pool-max-conn <max>
11920 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
11921 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
11922 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
11923 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
11924 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
11925 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
11926
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011927pool-purge-delay <delay>
11928 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010011929 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020011930 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010011931
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011932port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011933 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11934 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11935 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11936 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11937 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11938 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11939
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020011940proto <name>
11941
11942 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
11943 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
11944 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
11945 reported in haproxy -vv.
11946 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11947 protocol for all connections established to this server.
11948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011949redir <prefix>
11950 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11951 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11952 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11953 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11954 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11955 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11956 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11957 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011958 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011959 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011960 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11961 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11962 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11963 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11964
11965 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011967rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011968 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11969 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11970 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11971
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011972resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
11973 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
11974 server.
11975
11976 Available options:
11977
11978 * allow-dup-ip
11979 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
11980 resolution at runtime is in operation.
11981 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
11982 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
11983 For such case, simply enable this option.
11984 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
11985
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050011986 * ignore-weight
11987 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
11988 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
11989 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
11990
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020011991 * prevent-dup-ip
11992 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
11993 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
11994 same fqdn.
11995 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
11996
11997 Example:
11998 backend b_myapp
11999 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12000 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12001 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12002
12003 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12004 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12005 it
12006 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12007 different address
12008
12009 Default value: not set
12010
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012011resolve-prefer <family>
12012 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12013 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12014 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12015 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12016
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012017 Default value: ipv6
12018
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012019 Example:
12020
12021 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012022
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012023resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012024 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012025 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012026 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012027 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12028 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012029 configured network, another address is selected.
12030
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012031 Example:
12032
12033 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012034
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012035resolvers <id>
12036 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12037 hostname.
12038
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012039 Example:
12040
12041 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012042
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012043 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012044
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012045send-proxy
12046 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12047 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12048 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12049 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012050 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12051 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12052 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12053 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12054 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12055 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12056 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12057 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12058 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12059 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012060 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12061 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012062
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012063send-proxy-v2
12064 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12065 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12066 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12067 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012068 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12069 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12070 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12071 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012072
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012073proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12074 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12075 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012076 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12077 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012078 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12079 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012080 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012081
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012082send-proxy-v2-ssl
12083 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12084 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12085 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12086 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12087 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12088 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12089 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012090 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12091 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012092
12093send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12094 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12095 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12096 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12097 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12098 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12099 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12100 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12101 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012102 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12103 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012105slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012106 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12107 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12108 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12109 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12110 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12111 parameters :
12112
12113 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12114 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12115
12116 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12117 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12118 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12119 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12120
12121 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12122 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12123 seen as failed.
12124
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012125sni <expression>
12126 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12127 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12128 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12129 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012130 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12131 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012132 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012133 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12134 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012135
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012136source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012137source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012138source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012139 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12140 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12141 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12142 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12143
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012144 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12145 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12146 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12147 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12148 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12149 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12150 server.
12151
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012152 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12153 specifying the source address without port(s).
12154
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012155ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012156 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12157 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12158 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12159 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12160 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12161 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012162 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12163 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012164
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012165ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12166 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12167 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12168 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12169
12170ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12171 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12172 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12173 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12174
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012175ssl-reuse
12176 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12177 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12178 default value.
12179 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12180 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12181
12182stick
12183 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12184 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12185 default value.
12186 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12187 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012188
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012189socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012190 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012191 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12192 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12193
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012194tcp-ut <delay>
12195 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12196 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12197 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012198 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012199 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12200 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12201 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12202 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12203 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12204 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12205 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12206 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12207 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12208
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012209tfo
12210 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12211 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12212 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12213 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12214 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012215 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012217track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012218 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12219 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12220 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12221 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012222 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12223
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012224tls-tickets
12225 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12226 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12227 default value.
12228 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12229 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012230
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012231verify [none|required]
12232 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012233 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012234 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12235 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012236 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012237 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12238 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12239 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12240 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12241 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12242 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12243 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12244 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012245
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012246verifyhost <hostname>
12247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012248 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12249 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12250 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12251 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12252 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12253 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12254 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12255 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012257weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012258 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12259 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12260 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012261 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12262 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12263 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12264 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12265 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12266 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012267
12268
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122695.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12270-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012271
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012272HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12273using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12274configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012275This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12276can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12277workload.
12278This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12279resolution at run time.
12280Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12281carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12282
12283
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200122845.3.1. Global overview
12285----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012286
12287As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12288different steps of the process life:
12289
12290 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12291 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12292 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12293
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012294 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12295 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012296
12297A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12298 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12299 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12300 resolution to know this new IP.
12301
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012302When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012303HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012304SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12305from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12306will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12307will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012308
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012309A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012310 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012311 first valid response.
12312
12313 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12314 servers return an error.
12315
12316
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123175.3.2. The resolvers section
12318----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012319
12320This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012321HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12322contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012323
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012324When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12325uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12326is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12327answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12328
12329When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012330used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012331
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012332 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12333 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12334 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012335
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012336 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12337 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012338
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012339 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12340 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12341 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012342
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012343For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12344following scenarios are possible:
12345
12346 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12347 ignored
12348
12349 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12350 applied
12351
12352 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12353 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12354
12355 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12356 retries the query with a new type
12357
12358 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12359 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012360
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012361As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12362a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012363<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012364
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012365
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012366resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012367 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012368
12369A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12370
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012371accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012372 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012373 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012374 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12375 by RFC 6891)
12376
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012377 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12378
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012379nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12380 DNS server description:
12381 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12382 <ip> : IP address of the server
12383 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12384
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012385parse-resolv-conf
12386 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12387 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12388 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12389
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012390hold <status> <period>
12391 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12392 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012393 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012394 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012395 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12396 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12397 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12398
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012399 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012400
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012401resolve_retries <nb>
12402 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12403 giving up.
12404 Default value: 3
12405
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012406 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12407 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12408 type.
12409
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012410timeout <event> <time>
12411 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12412 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12413 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012414 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12415 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012416 Default value: 1s
12417 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012418 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012419 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012420 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12421 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12422
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012423 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012424
12425 resolvers mydns
12426 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12427 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012428 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012429 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012430 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012431 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012432 hold other 30s
12433 hold refused 30s
12434 hold nx 30s
12435 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012436 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012437 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012438
12439
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200124406. Cache
12441---------
12442
12443HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12444(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12445RAM.
12446
12447The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12448this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12449
12450If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12451independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12452when we try to allocate a new one.
12453
12454The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12455
12456It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12457"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12458for more details.
12459
12460When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12461replaced by "<CACHE>".
12462
12463
124646.1. Limitation
12465----------------
12466
12467The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12468
12469- If the response is not a 200
12470- If the response contains a Vary header
12471- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12472- If the response is not cacheable
12473
12474- If the request is not a GET
12475- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12476- If the request contains an Authorization header
12477
12478
124796.2. Setup
12480-----------
12481
12482To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12483the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12484
12485
124866.2.1. Cache section
12487---------------------
12488
12489cache <name>
12490 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12491 size of cache is mandatory.
12492
12493total-max-size <megabytes>
12494 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12495 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12496
12497max-object-size <bytes>
12498 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12499 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12500 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12501
12502max-age <seconds>
12503 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12504 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12505 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12506 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12507 default.
12508
12509
125106.2.2. Proxy section
12511---------------------
12512
12513http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12514 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12515 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12516 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12517 after this one.
12518
12519http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12520 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12521 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12522 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12523 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12524
12525
12526Example:
12527
12528 backend bck1
12529 mode http
12530
12531 http-request cache-use foobar
12532 http-response cache-store foobar
12533 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12534
12535 cache foobar
12536 total-max-size 4
12537 max-age 240
12538
12539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125407. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12541----------------------------------
12542
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012543HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012544client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12545The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12546these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12547but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12548data called patterns.
12549
12550
125517.1. ACL basics
12552---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012553
12554The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12555content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12556from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12557simple :
12558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012559 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012560 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012561 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12562 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012564The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12565adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012566
12567In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012569 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012570
12571This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12572Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12573and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012574an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12575conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12576as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12577are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012578
12579ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12580'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12581which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12582
12583There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12584performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012586The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12587specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12588this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012589methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12590ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012591
12592Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12593 - boolean
12594 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12595 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12596 - string
12597 - data block
12598
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012599Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12600converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12601would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12602The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12603which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12604
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012605Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12606keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12607fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12608which are summarized in the table below :
12609
12610 +---------------------+-----------------+
12611 | Sample or converter | Default |
12612 | output type | matching method |
12613 +---------------------+-----------------+
12614 | boolean | bool |
12615 +---------------------+-----------------+
12616 | integer | int |
12617 +---------------------+-----------------+
12618 | ip | ip |
12619 +---------------------+-----------------+
12620 | string | str |
12621 +---------------------+-----------------+
12622 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12623 +---------------------+-----------------+
12624
12625Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12626matching method, see below.
12627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012628The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12629 - boolean
12630 - integer or integer range
12631 - IP address / network
12632 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12633 - regular expression
12634 - hex block
12635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012636The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12637
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012638 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12639 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012640 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012641 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012642 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012643 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012644 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012646The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12647read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12648if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12649lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12650will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12651beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12652a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12653lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12654exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12655
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012656The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12657parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12658ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12659a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12660check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12661
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012662The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12663socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12664file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012666Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12667loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12668
12669 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12670
12671In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12672the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12673case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12674as well.
12675
12676The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12677sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12678do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12679methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12680is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012681obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012682followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12683default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12684that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12685string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12686
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012687The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12688By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12689string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12690resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12691server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012692waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012693flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12694function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012696There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12697sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12698be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012699
12700 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12701 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012702 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12703 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12704 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12705 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012706
12707 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12708 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012709 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012710
12711 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012712 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012713
12714 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012715 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012716
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012717 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012718 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12719
12720 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12721 binary or string samples.
12722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012723 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12724 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012726 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12727 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12728 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012730 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12731 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012733 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12734 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012736 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12737 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012739 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12740 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012741 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012743 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12744 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12745 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012746
12747For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12748request, it is possible to do :
12749
12750 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12751
12752In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12753buffer, one would use the following acl :
12754
12755 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12756
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012757On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12758possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12759
12760 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012762All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12763criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12764method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12765to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12766criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12767the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012769If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012770the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12771For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012773 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12774 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12775 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12776 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012777
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012778
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012779The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12780types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12781combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12782brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12783default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012785 +-------------------------------------------------+
12786 | Input sample type |
12787 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012788 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012789 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12790 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12791 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012792 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012793 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012794 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012795 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012796 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012797 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012798 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012799 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012800 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012801 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012802 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012803 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012804 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012805 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012806 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012807 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012808 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012809 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012810 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012811 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012812 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012813 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12814 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12815 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012816
12817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128187.1.1. Matching booleans
12819------------------------
12820
12821In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12822Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12823When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12824that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12825
12826Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12827return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12828"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12829
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128317.1.2. Matching integers
12832------------------------
12833
12834Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12835enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12836to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12837
12838Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12839matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12840lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012841
12842For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12843unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12844representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12845
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012846As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12847two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12848instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12849ranges and operators.
12850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012851For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012852operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12853Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12854of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012855
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012856Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012857
12858 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12859 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12860 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12861 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12862 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012864For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012865
12866 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12867
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012868This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12869
12870 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12871
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128737.1.3. Matching strings
12874-----------------------
12875
12876String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12877different forms :
12878
12879 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012880 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012881
12882 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012883 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012884
12885 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12886 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12887
12888 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12889 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12890
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012891 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012892 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12893 matches.
12894
12895 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12896 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12897 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012898
12899String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12900exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12901characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12902string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12903to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012904before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012905
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010012906Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
12907(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
12908Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
12909
12910Example:
12911 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
12912 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
12913
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129157.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12916---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012917
12918Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12919they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12920possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12921passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12922the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012923the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12924match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012925
12926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129277.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12928-------------------------------------
12929
12930It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12931not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12932a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12933to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12934digits may be used upper or lower case.
12935
12936Example :
12937 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12938 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12939
12940
129417.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12942---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012943
12944IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12945netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12946within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012947host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012948difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12949at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12950does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12951parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012952
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012953The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12954abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12955
12956 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12957 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12958 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12959 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12960 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12961 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12962 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12963 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12964
12965Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12966192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12967
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012968IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12969Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12970trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12971IPv6 patterns.
12972
12973HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12974following situations :
12975 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12976 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12977 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12978 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12979 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12980 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12981 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12982 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12983 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12984 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012986
129877.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12988----------------------------------
12989
12990Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12991combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12992
12993 - AND (implicit)
12994 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12995 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012997A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012999 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13002indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13005"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13006requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13007is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13008
13009 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013010 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13011 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13012 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013013
13014To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13015and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13016
13017 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13018 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13019 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13020 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13021
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013022 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013023 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13024 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13025 use_backend www if host_www
13026
13027It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13028expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13029be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13030the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13031
13032 The following rule :
13033
13034 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013035 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013036
13037 Can also be written that way :
13038
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013039 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013040
13041It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13042to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13043simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13044sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13045good use is the following :
13046
13047 With named ACLs :
13048
13049 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13050 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13051 monitor fail if site_dead
13052
13053 With anonymous ACLs :
13054
13055 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13056
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013057See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13058keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013059
13060
130617.3. Fetching samples
13062---------------------
13063
13064Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13065against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13066sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13067ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13068of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13069available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13070
13071This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13072Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13073compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13074deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13075
13076The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13077matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13078method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13079indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13080
13081As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13082when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13083mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13084the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13085ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13086
13087Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13088multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13089when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013090incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13091are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013092is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13093all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13094
13095Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13096 - name
13097 - name(arg1)
13098 - name(arg1,arg2)
13099
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013100
131017.3.1. Converters
13102-----------------
13103
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013104Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13105of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13106is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13107was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013108has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013109unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13110
13111These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13112sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13113the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013114support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013115
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013116A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13117support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13118supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13119(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13120bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013122The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013123
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001312451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13125 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13126 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13127 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13128 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13129 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13130
13131 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013132 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13133 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013134 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13135 frontend http-in
13136 bind *:8081
13137 default_backend servers
13138 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13139 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13140
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013141add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013142 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013143 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013144 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13145 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013146 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013147 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13148 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13149 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13150 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013151 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013152 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013153
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013154aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13155 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13156 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13157 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13158 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13159 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13160 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13161
13162 Example:
13163 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13164 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13165
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013166and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013167 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013168 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013169 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13170 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013171 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013172 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13173 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13174 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13175 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013176 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013177 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013178
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013179b64dec
13180 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13181 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13182
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013183base64
13184 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013185 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013186 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13187
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013188bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013189 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013190 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013191 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013192 presence of a flag).
13193
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013194bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13195 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13196 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013197 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013198
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013199concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13200 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13201 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13202 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13203 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13204 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13205 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13206 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13207 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13208 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13209 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013210 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013211 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013212 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013213
13214 Example:
13215 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13216 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13217 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13218 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13219
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013220cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013221 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13222 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013223
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013224crc32([<avalanche>])
13225 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13226 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13227 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13228 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13229 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13230 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13231 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13232 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13233 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13234 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013235 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13236
13237crc32c([<avalanche>])
13238 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13239 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13240 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13241 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13242 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13243 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13244 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13245 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013246
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013247da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013248 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13249 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13250 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13251 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013252 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013253 configuration language.
13254
13255 Example:
13256 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013257 bind *:8881
13258 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013259 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013260
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013261debug
13262 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13263 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13264 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13265
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013266div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013267 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13268 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013269 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013270 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13271 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013272 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013273 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13274 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13275 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13276 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013277 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013278 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013279
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013280djb2([<avalanche>])
13281 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13282 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13283 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13284 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13285 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13286 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13287 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013288 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13289 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013290
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013291even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013292 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013293 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13294
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013295field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13296 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13297 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13298 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13299 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13300 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13301 fields.
13302
13303 Example :
13304 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13305 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13306 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13307 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13308 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013309
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013310hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013311 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013312 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013313 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013314 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013315
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013316hex2i
13317 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013318 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013319
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013320http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013321 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13322 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013323 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13324 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13325 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13326 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13327 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13328 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13329 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13330 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013331
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013332in_table(<table>)
13333 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13334 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13335 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013336 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013337 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13338
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013339ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13340 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013341 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013342 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13343 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13344 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13345 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13346 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013347
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013348json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013349 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013350 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013351 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013352 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13353 of errors:
13354 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13355 bytes, ...)
13356 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13357 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13358
13359 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13360 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13361 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13362 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13363 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13364 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013365 - "ascii" : never fails;
13366 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13367 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013368 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013369 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013370 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13371 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13372
13373 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013374 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013375
13376 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013377 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013378 capture request header user-agent len 150
13379 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013380
13381 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13382 GET / HTTP/1.0
13383 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13384
13385 Output log:
13386 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13387
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013388language(<value>[,<default>])
13389 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13390 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13391 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13392 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13393 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13394 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13395 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13396 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13397 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013398 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013399 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13400 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013401
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013402 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013403
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013404 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13405 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013406
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013407 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13408 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13409 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13410 use_backend spanish if es
13411 use_backend french if fr
13412 use_backend english if en
13413 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013414
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013415length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013416 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13417 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13418 type. The result is of type integer.
13419
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013420lower
13421 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13422 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13423 type. The result is of type string.
13424
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013425ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13426 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13427 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13428 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13429 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13430 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13431 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13432
13433 Example :
13434
13435 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013436 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013437 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13438
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013439map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13440map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13441map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13442 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13443 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13444 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13445 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13446 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13447 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13448 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13449 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013450
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013451 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13452 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13453 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013454
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013455 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013456 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013457
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013458 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13459 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13460 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13461 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013462 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13463 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013464 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13465 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13466 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13467 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13468 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13469 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13470 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13471 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013472 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13473 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13474 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013475 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13476 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13477 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13478 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13479 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013480
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013481 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13482 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13483 the corresponding match text.
13484
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013485 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13486 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13487 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13488 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13489 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013490
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013491 Example :
13492
13493 # this is a comment and is ignored
13494 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13495 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13496 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13497 | | | `---------- value
13498 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13499 | `---------------------------- key
13500 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13501
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013502mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013503 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13504 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013505 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013506 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013507 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013508 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13509 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13510 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13511 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013512 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013513 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013514
13515mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013516 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013517 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13518 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013519 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013520 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013521 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013522 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13523 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13524 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13525 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013526 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013527 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013528
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013529nbsrv
13530 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13531 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13532 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13533 map lookup.
13534
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013535neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013536 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13537 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13538 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13539 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013540
13541not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013542 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013543 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013544 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013545 absence of a flag).
13546
13547odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013548 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013549 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13550
13551or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013552 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013553 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013554 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13555 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013556 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013557 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13558 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13559 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13560 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013561 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013562 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013563
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013564protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13565 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13566 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13567 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13568 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13569 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13570 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13571 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13572 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13573 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13574 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13575 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13576
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013577regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013578 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13579 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13580 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13581 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13582 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13583 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13584 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13585 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13586 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13587 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013588 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13589 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13590 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13591 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013592
13593 Example :
13594
13595 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13596 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13597 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13598 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13599
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013600capture-req(<id>)
13601 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13602 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13603
13604 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013605 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13606 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013607
13608capture-res(<id>)
13609 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13610 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13611
13612 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013613 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13614 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013615
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013616sdbm([<avalanche>])
13617 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13618 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13619 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13620 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13621 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13622 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13623 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013624 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13625 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013626
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013627set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013628 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13629 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13630 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013631 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013632 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13633 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013634 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013635 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13636 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013637 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013638 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013639
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013640sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013641 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013642 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13643
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013644sha2([<bits>])
13645 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13646 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13647
13648 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13649 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13650
13651 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13652 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13653
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013654srv_queue
13655 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13656 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13657 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13658 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13659 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13660
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013661strcmp(<var>)
13662 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13663 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13664 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13665 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13666 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13667 shorter).
13668
13669 Example :
13670
13671 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13672 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13673 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13674
13675
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013676sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013677 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13678 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013679 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013680 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13681 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013682 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013683 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13684 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013685 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013686 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13687 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013688 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013689 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013690
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013691table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13692 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13693 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13694 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13695 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13696 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13697 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13698
13699
13700table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13701 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13702 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13703 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13704 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13705 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13706 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13707
13708table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13709 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13710 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013711 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013712 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13713 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13714
13715table_conn_cur(<table>)
13716 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13717 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13718 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13719 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13720 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13721
13722table_conn_rate(<table>)
13723 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13724 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13725 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13726 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13727 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13728
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013729table_gpt0(<table>)
13730 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13731 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13732 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13733 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13734 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13735
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013736table_gpc0(<table>)
13737 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13738 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13739 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13740 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13741 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13742
13743table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13744 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13745 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13746 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13747 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13748 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13749 sample fetch keyword.
13750
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013751table_gpc1(<table>)
13752 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13753 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13754 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13755 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13756 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13757
13758table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13759 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13760 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13761 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13762 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13763 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13764 sample fetch keyword.
13765
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013766table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13767 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13768 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013769 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013770 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13771 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13772
13773table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13774 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13775 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13776 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13777 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13778 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13779 keyword.
13780
13781table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13782 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13783 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013784 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013785 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13786 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13787
13788table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13789 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13790 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13791 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13792 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13793 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13794 keyword.
13795
13796table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13797 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13798 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013799 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013800 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13801 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13802 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13803 keyword.
13804
13805table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13806 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13807 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013808 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013809 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13810 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13811 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13812 keyword.
13813
13814table_server_id(<table>)
13815 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13816 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13817 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13818 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13819 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13820 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13821
13822table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13823 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13824 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013825 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013826 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13827 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13828 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13829 keyword.
13830
13831table_sess_rate(<table>)
13832 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13833 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13834 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13835 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13836 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13837 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13838 keyword.
13839
13840table_trackers(<table>)
13841 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13842 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13843 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13844 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13845 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13846 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13847 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13848 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13849 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13850 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13851
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013852upper
13853 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13854 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13855 type. The result is of type string.
13856
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013857url_dec
13858 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13859 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13860
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013861ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013862 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013863 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13864 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13865 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013866 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13867 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13868 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13869 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013870 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013871 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13872 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013873
13874 Example:
13875 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13876 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13877
13878 message Point {
13879 int32 latitude = 1;
13880 int32 longitude = 2;
13881 }
13882
13883 message PPoint {
13884 Point point = 59;
13885 }
13886
13887 message Rectangle {
13888 // One corner of the rectangle.
13889 PPoint lo = 48;
13890 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13891 PPoint hi = 49;
13892 }
13893
13894 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13895 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13896 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13897
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013898 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13899 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013900 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013901 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13902
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013903 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013904
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013905 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013906
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013907 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013908 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13909 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13910
13911 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13912 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13913 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13914
13915 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13916 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13917 interpret the previous binary sample.
13918
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013919
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013920unset-var(<var name>)
13921 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13922 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13923 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13924 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13925 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13926 response),
13927 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13928 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13929 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13930 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13931
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013932utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13933 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13934 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13935 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13936 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13937 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13938 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13939
13940 Example :
13941
13942 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013943 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013944 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13945
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013946word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13947 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13948 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13949 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13950 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13951 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13952
13953 Example :
13954 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13955 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13956 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13957 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13958 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013959
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013960wt6([<avalanche>])
13961 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13962 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13963 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13964 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13965 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13966 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13967 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013968 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13969 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013970
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013971xor(<value>)
13972 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013973 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013974 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013975 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013976 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013977 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13978 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013979 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013980 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13981 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013982 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013983 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013984
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013985xxh32([<seed>])
13986 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13987 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13988 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13989 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13990 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13991 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13992 as cryptographically secure.
13993
13994xxh64([<seed>])
13995 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13996 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13997 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13998 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13999 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14000 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14001 as cryptographically secure.
14002
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014003
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140047.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014005--------------------------------------------
14006
14007A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14008not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14009"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14010The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14011
14012always_false : boolean
14013 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14014 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14015
14016always_true : boolean
14017 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14018 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14019
14020avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014021 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014022 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14023 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14024 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14025 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14026 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14027 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14028 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14029 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14030 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14031 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14032 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14033 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14034 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014036be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014037 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14038 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14039 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14040 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014041 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14042
14043be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14044 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14045 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14046 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14047 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14048 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014049 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14050 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014051
14052 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14053 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14054 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014056be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14057 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14058 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14059 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014060 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014061 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14062 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014063
14064 Example :
14065 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14066 backend dynamic
14067 mode http
14068 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14069 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014070
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014071bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014072 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14073 of the string.
14074
14075bool(<bool>) : bool
14076 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14077 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014079connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14080 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014081 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014082 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14083 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014084
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014085 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014086 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014087 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14088
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014089 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14090 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014091
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014092 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014093 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014094 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014095 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014096 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014097 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014098 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014099
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014100 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14101 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014102 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014103 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014104
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014105cpu_calls : integer
14106 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14107 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14108 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14109 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14110 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14111 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14112
14113cpu_ns_avg : integer
14114 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14115 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14116 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14117 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14118 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14119 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14120 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14121 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14122 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14123 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14124 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14125
14126cpu_ns_tot : integer
14127 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14128 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14129 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14130 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14131 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14132 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14133 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14134 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14135 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14136 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14137 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14138 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14139 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14140
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014141date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014142 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014143
14144 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14145 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14146 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014147 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14148
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014149 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14150 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14151 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14152 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14153 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14154
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014155 Example :
14156
14157 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14158 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014159
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014160 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14161 # millisecond granularity
14162 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14163
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014164date_us : integer
14165 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14166 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14167 from the same timeval structure.
14168
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014169distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14170 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14171 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14172 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14173 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14174 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14175 list of supported tokens.
14176
14177distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14178 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14179 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14180 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14181 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14182 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14183 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14184 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14185 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14186 supported tokens.
14187
14188 Example :
14189 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14190 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14191 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14192 # send large files to the big farm
14193 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14194
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014195env(<name>) : string
14196 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14197 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14198 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14199 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14200 certain way.
14201
14202 Examples :
14203 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14204 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14205
14206 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14207 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014209fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14210 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014211 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14212 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014213 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14214 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014215 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014216 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14217 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014218
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014219fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14220 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14221 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14222 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014224fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14225 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14226 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14227 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14228 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14229 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14230 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14231 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14232 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014233
14234 Example :
14235 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14236 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14237 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14238 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14239 frontend mail
14240 bind :25
14241 mode tcp
14242 maxconn 100
14243 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14244 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14245 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14246 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014247
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014248hostname : string
14249 Returns the system hostname.
14250
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014251int(<integer>) : signed integer
14252 Returns a signed integer.
14253
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014254ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14255 Returns an ipv4.
14256
14257ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14258 Returns an ipv6.
14259
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014260lat_ns_avg : integer
14261 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14262 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14263 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14264 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14265 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14266 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14267 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14268 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14269 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14270 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14271 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14272 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14273 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14274 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14275
14276lat_ns_tot : integer
14277 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14278 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14279 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14280 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14281 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14282 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14283 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14284 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14285 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14286 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14287 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14288 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14289 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14290 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14291 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14292 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14293 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14294 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14295 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14296
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014297meth(<method>) : method
14298 Returns a method.
14299
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014300nbproc : integer
14301 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14302 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14303 and debugging purposes.
14304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014305nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14306 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14307 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14308 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014309 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14310 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14311 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014312
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014313prio_class : integer
14314 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14315 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14316 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14317
14318prio_offset : integer
14319 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14320 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14321 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14322 set-priority-offset".
14323
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014324proc : integer
14325 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14326 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14327 debugging purposes.
14328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014329queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014330 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14331 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14332 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014333 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14334 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14335 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14336 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14337 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14338
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014339rand([<range>]) : integer
14340 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14341 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14342 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14343 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14344 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14345
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014346uuid([<version>]) : string
14347 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14348 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14349 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014351srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14352 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14353 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14354 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14355 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14356 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014357 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14358 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14359
14360srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14361 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14362 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14363 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14364 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14365 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14366 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14367 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14368
14369 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14370 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371
14372srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14373 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14374 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14375 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014376 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14378 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14379 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14380
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014381srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14382 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14383 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14384 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14385 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14386 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14387 fetch methods.
14388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014389srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14390 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14391 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014392 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014393 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14394 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014395 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014396 overloading servers).
14397
14398 Example :
14399 # Redirect to a separate back
14400 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14401 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14402 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14403
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014404stopping : boolean
14405 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14406 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14407 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14408
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014409str(<string>) : string
14410 Returns a string.
14411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014412table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14413 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14414 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14415
14416table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14417 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14418 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14419 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14420
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014421thread : integer
14422 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14423 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14424 and debugging purposes.
14425
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014426var(<var-name>) : undefined
14427 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014428 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14429 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014430 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014431 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14432 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014433 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014434 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14435 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014436 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014437 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014438
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144397.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014440----------------------------------
14441
14442The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14443closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14444methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14445sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14446TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014447the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14448counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014449"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14450used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14451can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14452Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14453table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14454tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14455currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014456
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014457bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014458 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14459 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14460 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014462be_id : integer
14463 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14464 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14465
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014466be_name : string
14467 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14468 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014470dst : ip
14471 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14472 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14473 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14474 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014475 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14476 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14477 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14478 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14479 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14480 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014481
14482dst_conn : integer
14483 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14484 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14485 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14486 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14487 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14488 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14489 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14490 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014491
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014492dst_is_local : boolean
14493 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14494 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14495 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14496 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014497 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014498 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14499 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14500 it only once per connection.
14501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014502dst_port : integer
14503 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14504 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14505 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14506 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14507 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14508 an HTTP header.
14509
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014510fc_http_major : integer
14511 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14512 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14513 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14514
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014515fc_pp_authority : string
14516 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14517 if any.
14518
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014519fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14520 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14521 header.
14522
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014523fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14524 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14525 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14526 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14527 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14528 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14529 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14530
14531fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14532 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14533 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14534 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14535 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14536 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14537 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14538
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014539fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014540 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14541 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14542 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14543 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14544
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014545fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014546 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14547 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14548 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14549 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14550
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014551fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014552 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14553 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14554 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14555 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14556
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014557fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014558 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14559 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14560 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14561 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14562
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014563fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014564 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14565 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14566 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14567 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14568
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014569fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014570 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14571 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14572 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14573 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14574
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014575fe_defbe : string
14576 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14577 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014579fe_id : integer
14580 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014581 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014582 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14583
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014584fe_name : string
14585 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14586 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14587 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14588
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014589sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014590sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14591sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14592sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014593 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14594 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14595 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14596
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014597sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014598sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14599sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14600sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014601 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14602 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14603 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14604
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014605sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014606sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14607sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14608sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014609 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14610 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014611 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14612 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14613 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014614
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014615 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014616 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14617 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014618 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14619 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14620 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014621 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14622 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14623
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014624sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14625sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14626sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14627sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14628 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14629 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14630 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14631 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14632 when a first ACL was verified.
14633
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014634sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014635sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14636sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14637sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014638 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014639 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14640
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014641sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014642sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14643sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14644sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014645 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14646 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14647 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14648
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014649sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014650sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14651sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14652sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014653 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14654 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14655 See also src_conn_rate.
14656
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014657sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014658sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14659sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14660sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014661 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014662 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014663
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014664sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14665sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14666sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14667sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14668 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14669 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14670
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014671sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14672sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14673sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14674sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14675 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14676 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14677
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014678sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014679sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14680sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14681sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014682 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14683 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14684 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014685 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14686 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14687 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014688
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014689sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14690sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14691sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14692sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14693 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14694 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14695 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14696 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14697 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14698 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14699
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014700sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014701sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14702sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14703sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014704 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014705 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14706 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14707
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014708sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014709sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14710sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14711sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014712 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14713 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14714 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14715 src_http_err_rate.
14716
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014717sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014718sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14719sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14720sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014721 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014722 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14723 src_http_req_cnt.
14724
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014725sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014726sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14727sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14728sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014729 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14730 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14731 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14732 src_http_req_rate.
14733
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014734sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014735sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14736sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14737sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014738 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014739 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14740 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14741 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14742 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014743
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014744 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014745 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14746 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014747 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14748
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014749sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14750sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14751sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14752sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14753 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14754 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14755 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14756 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14757 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14758
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014759sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014760sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14761sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14762sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014763 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14764 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14765 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014766
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014767sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014768sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14769sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14770sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014771 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14772 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14773 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014774
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014775sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014776sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14777sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14778sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014779 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014780 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14781 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14782 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014783 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014784 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14785
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014786sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014787sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14788sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14789sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014790 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14791 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14792 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14793 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14794 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014795 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014796
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014797sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014798sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14799sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14800sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014801 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14802 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14803 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14804
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014805sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014806sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14807sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14808sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014809 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14810 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014811 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014812 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14813 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014814 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14815 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14816 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014818so_id : integer
14819 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14820 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14821 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014823src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014824 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14826 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14827 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014828 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14829 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14830 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014831 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14832 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14833 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14834 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14835 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14836 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14837 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014838
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014839 Example:
14840 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14841 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014843src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14844 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14845 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14846 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014847 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014849src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14850 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14851 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014852 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014853 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014855src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14856 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14857 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14858 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14859 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14860 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14861 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014862
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014863 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014864 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14865 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14866 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14867 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014868 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014869 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14870 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14871
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014872src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14873 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14874 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14875 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14876 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14877 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14878 was verified.
14879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014880src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014881 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014883 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014884 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014887 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14889 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014890 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014892src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14893 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14894 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14895 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014896 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014898src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014899 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014901 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014902 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014903
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014904src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14905 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14906 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14907 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14908 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14909
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014910src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14911 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14912 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14913 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14914 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014917 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014919 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14920 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014921 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14922 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14923 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014924
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014925src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14926 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14927 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14928 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14929 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14930 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14931 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14932 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014934src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014935 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014936 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014937 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014938 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014941src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14942 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14943 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14944 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14945 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014946 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014948src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014949 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14951 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014952 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014954src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14955 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14956 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14957 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014958 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014959 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014961src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14962 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14963 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14964 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014965 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014966 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14967 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014968
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014969 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014970 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014971 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014972 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014973
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014974src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14975 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14976 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14977 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14978 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14979 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14980 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14981
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014982src_is_local : boolean
14983 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14984 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14985 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14986 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014987 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014988 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14989 once per connection.
14990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014991src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014992 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14993 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14994 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14995 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14996 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014998src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014999 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15000 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15001 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15002 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15003 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015005src_port : integer
15006 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15007 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15008 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15009 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015011src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015012 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015013 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15014 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15015 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015016 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015018src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15019 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15020 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15021 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15022 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015023 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015025src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15026 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15027 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15028 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15029 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15030 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15031 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15032 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15033 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015034
15035 Example :
15036 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15037 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15038 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15039 listen ssh
15040 bind :22
15041 mode tcp
15042 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015043 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015044 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015045 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015047srv_id : integer
15048 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15049 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15050 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015051
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015052srv_name : string
15053 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15054 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15055 debugging.
15056
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150577.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015058----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015060The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15061closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15062when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15063usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015064future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015065
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001506651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15067 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15068 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15069 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15070 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15071 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15072
15073 Example :
15074 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15075 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15076 # the request.
15077 frontend http-in
15078 bind *:8081
15079 default_backend servers
15080 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15081 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15082
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015083ssl_bc : boolean
15084 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15085 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15086 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15087
15088ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15089 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15090 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15091
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015092ssl_bc_alpn : string
15093 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15094 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015095 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015096 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15097 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15098 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15099 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15100 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15101 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15102
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015103ssl_bc_cipher : string
15104 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15105 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15106
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015107ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15108 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15109 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15110 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15111
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015112ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15113 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15114 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15115 session or a TLS ticket.
15116
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015117ssl_bc_npn : string
15118 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15119 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015120 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015121 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15122 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15123 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15124 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15125 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15126
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015127ssl_bc_protocol : string
15128 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15129 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15130
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015131ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015132 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015133 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15134 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015135
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015136ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15137 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15138 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15139 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15140
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015141ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15142 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15143 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15144 if session was reused or not.
15145
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015146ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15147 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15148 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15149 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15150 BoringSSL.
15151
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015152ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15153 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15154 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015156ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15157 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15158 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15159 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15160 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15161 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015163ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15164 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15165 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15166 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15167 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015168
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015169ssl_c_der : binary
15170 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15171 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15172 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015174ssl_c_err : integer
15175 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15176 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15177 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15178 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15179 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15182 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15183 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15184 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15185 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15186 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15187 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15188 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15189 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015191ssl_c_key_alg : string
15192 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15193 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15194 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015196ssl_c_notafter : string
15197 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15198 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15199 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015201ssl_c_notbefore : string
15202 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15203 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15204 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015206ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15207 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15208 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15209 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15210 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15211 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15212 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15213 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15214 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216ssl_c_serial : binary
15217 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15218 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15219 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015221ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15222 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15223 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15224 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015225 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15226 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15227
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015228 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015229 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15232 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15233 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15234 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236ssl_c_used : boolean
15237 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15238 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015240ssl_c_verify : integer
15241 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15242 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15243 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15244 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246ssl_c_version : integer
15247 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15248 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015249
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015250ssl_f_der : binary
15251 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15252 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15253 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015255ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15256 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15257 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15258 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15259 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015260 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015261 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15262 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15263 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015265ssl_f_key_alg : string
15266 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15267 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15268 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015270ssl_f_notafter : string
15271 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15272 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15273 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275ssl_f_notbefore : string
15276 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15277 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15278 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015280ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15281 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15282 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15283 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15284 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15285 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15286 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15287 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15288 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015290ssl_f_serial : binary
15291 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15292 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15293 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015294
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015295ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15296 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15297 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15298 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015300ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15301 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15302 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15303 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015305ssl_f_version : integer
15306 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15307 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15308
15309ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015310 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15311 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15312 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015314 Example :
15315 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15316 listen http-https
15317 bind :80
15318 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15319 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15320
15321ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15322 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15323 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15324
15325ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015326 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015327 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15328 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15329 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15330 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15331 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15332 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15333 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15334 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015336ssl_fc_cipher : string
15337 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15338 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015339
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015340ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15341 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15342 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015343 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015344
15345ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15346 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15347 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015348 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015349
15350ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15351 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15352 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15353 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015354 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015355 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015356
15357ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15358 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15359 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015360 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015361
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015362ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15363 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15364 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15365 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015367ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015368 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15369 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015370 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15371 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15372 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15373 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015374
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015375ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15376 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15377 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15378 wait until the handshake happened.
15379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015380ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15381 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015382 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15383 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015384 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015385 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015386
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015387ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015388 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015389 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15390 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015392ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015393 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015394 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15395 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15396 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15397 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15398 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15399 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15400 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015402ssl_fc_protocol : string
15403 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15404 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015405
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015406ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015407 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015408 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15409 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015410
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015411ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15412 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15413 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15414 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015416ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15417 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15418 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15419 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15420 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015421
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015422ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15423 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15424 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15425 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15426 BoringSSL.
15427
15428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015429ssl_fc_sni : string
15430 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15431 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15432 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15433 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15434 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15435
15436 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15437 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15438 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015439 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015440 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015442 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15444 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015446ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15447 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15448 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015449
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015450
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154517.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015452------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015454Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15455sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15456only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15457For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15458be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15459can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15460sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15461for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15462content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015464payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015465 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15467 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015469payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15470 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015471 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015473
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015474req.hdrs : string
15475 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15476 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15477 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15478 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15479
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015480req.hdrs_bin : binary
15481 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15482 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15483 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15484 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15485 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15486 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15487
15488 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15489
15490 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15491 str: <int:length><bytes>
15492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493req.len : integer
15494req_len : integer (deprecated)
15495 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15496 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15497 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15498 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15499 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15500 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15501 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15502 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015504req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15505 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015506 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15507 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15508 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15509 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511 ACL alternatives :
15512 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15515 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15516 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15517 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15518 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520 ACL alternatives :
15521 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015523 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015525req.proto_http : boolean
15526req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15527 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15528 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15529 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15530 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15531 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15532 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15533 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015535 Example:
15536 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15537 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15538 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015539 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015541req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15542rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15543 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15544 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15545 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15546 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15547 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15548 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15549 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15552 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15553 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15554 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15555 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15556 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558 ACL derivatives :
15559 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561 Example :
15562 listen tse-farm
15563 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15564 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15565 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15566 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15567 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15568 persist rdp-cookie
15569 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15570 # This is only useful makes sense if
15571 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15572 stick-table type string size 204800
15573 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15574 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15575 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015577 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15578 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015580req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15581rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15582 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15583 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15584 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15585 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015587 ACL derivatives :
15588 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015589
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015590req.ssl_alpn : string
15591 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15592 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15593 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15594 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15595 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15596 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015597 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015598
15599 Examples :
15600 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15601 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15602 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015603 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015604 default_backend bk_default
15605
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015606req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15607 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15608 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015609 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15610 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15611 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15612 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15613 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15616req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15617 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15618 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15619 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15620 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15621 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15622 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15623 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625req.ssl_sni : string
15626req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15627 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15628 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15629 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15630 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15631 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15632 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15633 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15634 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15635 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15636 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15637 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15638 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015640 ACL derivatives :
15641 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643 Examples :
15644 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15645 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15646 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15647 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15648 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015649
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015650req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15651 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15652 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15653 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15654 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15655 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15656 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15657 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15658 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15659 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661req.ssl_ver : integer
15662req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15663 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15664 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15665 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15666 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15667 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15668 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15669 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015670 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015671 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673 ACL derivatives :
15674 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015675
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015676res.len : integer
15677 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15678 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15679 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15680 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15681 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15682 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15683 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15684 content inspection.
15685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015686res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15687 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015688 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15689 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15690 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15691 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15694 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15695 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15696 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15697 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015700
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015701res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15702rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15703 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15704 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15705 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15706 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15707 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15708 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15709 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711wait_end : boolean
15712 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15713 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015714 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15716 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015717 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15719 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015721 Examples :
15722 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15723 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15724 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15727 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15728 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15729 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15730 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15731 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15732 tcp-request content reject
15733
15734
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157357.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736--------------------------------------
15737
15738It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15739This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15740data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15741its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15742HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15743content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15744to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15745more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15746response are indexed.
15747
15748base : string
15749 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15750 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15751 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15752 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15753 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15754 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15755 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15756 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15757
15758 ACL derivatives :
15759 base : exact string match
15760 base_beg : prefix match
15761 base_dir : subdir match
15762 base_dom : domain match
15763 base_end : suffix match
15764 base_len : length match
15765 base_reg : regex match
15766 base_sub : substring match
15767
15768base32 : integer
15769 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15770 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15771 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015772 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15773 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15774 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015775
15776base32+src : binary
15777 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15778 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15779 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15780 per-URL counters.
15781
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015782capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15783 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15784 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15785 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15786
15787capture.req.method : string
15788 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15789 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15790 because it's allocated.
15791
15792capture.req.uri : string
15793 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15794 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15795 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15796 allocated.
15797
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015798capture.req.ver : string
15799 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15800 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15801 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15802
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015803capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15804 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15805 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15806 The first entry is an index of 0.
15807 See also: "capture response header"
15808
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015809capture.res.ver : string
15810 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15811 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15812 persistent flag.
15813
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015814req.body : binary
15815 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15816 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15817 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15818 the first chunk is analyzed.
15819
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015820req.body_param([<name>) : string
15821 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15822 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15823 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15824 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15825 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15826 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15827 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15828 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15829 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15830 given.
15831
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015832req.body_len : integer
15833 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15834 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15835 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15836 "option http-buffer-request".
15837
15838req.body_size : integer
15839 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15840 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15841 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15842 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15843 "option http-buffer-request".
15844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015845req.cook([<name>]) : string
15846cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15847 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15848 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15849 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15850 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15851 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15852 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15853 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15854 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15855
15856 ACL derivatives :
15857 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15858 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15859 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15860 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15861 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15862 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15863 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15864 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015866req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15867cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15868 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15869 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15872cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15873 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15874 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15875 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15876 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015878cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15879 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15880 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15881 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15882 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015883 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015884 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15885 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15886 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15887 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015889hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15890 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15891 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15892 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15893 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015894 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015896req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15897 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15898 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15899 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15900 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15901 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15902 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15903 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15904 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15907 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15908 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15909 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15910 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015912req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15913 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15914 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15915 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15916 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15917 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15918 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15919 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15920 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015921 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015923 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015925 ACL derivatives :
15926 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15927 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15928 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15929 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15930 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15931 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15932 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15933 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15934
15935req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15936hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15937 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15938 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15939 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15940 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15941 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15942 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15943 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15944 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15945 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15946
15947req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15948hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15949 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15950 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15951 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15952 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15953 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015954 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015955 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15956 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15957
15958req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15959hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15960 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15961 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15962 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15963 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15964 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15965 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15966 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15967
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015968
15969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015970http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15971 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15972 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15973 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15974 basic auth is supported.
15975
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015976http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15977 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15978 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15979 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15980 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15982 basic auth is supported.
15983
15984 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015985 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15986 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15987 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15988 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015989
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020015990http_auth_pass : string
15991 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
15992 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15993 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15994
15995http_auth_type : string
15996 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
15997 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
15998 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
15999
16000http_auth_user : string
16001 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16002 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16003 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016006 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16007 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016008 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16009 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011method : integer + string
16012 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16013 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16014 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16015 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16016 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16017 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16018 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016020 ACL derivatives :
16021 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023 Example :
16024 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16025 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16026 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016028path : string
16029 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16030 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16031 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16032 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16033 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016034 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016037 ACL derivatives :
16038 path : exact string match
16039 path_beg : prefix match
16040 path_dir : subdir match
16041 path_dom : domain match
16042 path_end : suffix match
16043 path_len : length match
16044 path_reg : regex match
16045 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016046
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016047query : string
16048 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16049 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16050 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16051 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016052 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016053 which stops before the question mark.
16054
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016055req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16056 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16057 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16058 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16059 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016061req.ver : string
16062req_ver : string (deprecated)
16063 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16064 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16065 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016067 ACL derivatives :
16068 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016070res.comp : boolean
16071 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16072 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16073 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075res.comp_algo : string
16076 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16077 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16078 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016080res.cook([<name>]) : string
16081scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16082 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16083 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16084 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016086 ACL derivatives :
16087 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016089res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16090scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16091 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16092 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16093 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16096scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16097 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16098 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16099 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16102 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16103 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16104 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16105 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16106 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16107 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16108 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16109 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16110 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16113 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16114 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16115 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16116 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16117 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016119res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16120shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16121 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16122 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16123 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16124 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16125 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16126 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16127 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16128 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016130 ACL derivatives :
16131 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16132 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16133 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16134 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16135 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16136 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16137 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16138 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16139
16140res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16141shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16142 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16143 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16144 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16145 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16146 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16149shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16150 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16151 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16152 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16153 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16154 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16155 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016156
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016157res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16158 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16159 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16160 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16161 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016163res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16164shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16165 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16166 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16167 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16168 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16169 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16170 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016172res.ver : string
16173resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16174 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16175 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177 ACL derivatives :
16178 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016180set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16181 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16182 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016183 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016184 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16187 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189status : integer
16190 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16191 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16192 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016193
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016194unique-id : string
16195 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16196 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16197 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16198 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16199 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16200 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016202url : string
16203 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16204 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16205 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16206 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16207 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16208 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16209 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016211 ACL derivatives :
16212 url : exact string match
16213 url_beg : prefix match
16214 url_dir : subdir match
16215 url_dom : domain match
16216 url_end : suffix match
16217 url_len : length match
16218 url_reg : regex match
16219 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016221url_ip : ip
16222 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16223 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16224 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16225 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16226 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16227 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16228 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016230url_port : integer
16231 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16232 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16233 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16234 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016235
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016236urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16237url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016238 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16239 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016240 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16241 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16242 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16243 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016244 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16245 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016246 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16247 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249 ACL derivatives :
16250 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16251 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16252 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16253 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16254 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16255 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16256 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16257 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016258
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016260 Example :
16261 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16262 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16263 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16264 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016265
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016266urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16268 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16269 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016270
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016271url32 : integer
16272 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16273 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16274 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16275 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16276 is an unsigned integer.
16277
16278url32+src : binary
16279 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16280 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16281 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16282
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016285---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016287Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16288every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016289order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016291ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16292---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016293FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016294HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016295HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16296HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016297HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16298HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16299HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16300HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16301LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016302METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016303METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016304METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16305METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16306METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16307METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016308METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016309METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016310RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016311REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016312TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016313WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16314---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016315
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163178. Logging
16318----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016319
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016320One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16321provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16322very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16323provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16324state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016325to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016326headers.
16327
16328In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16329about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16330send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16331
16332 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16333 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16334 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16335 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16336 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016337 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016338 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016339
16340The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16341allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16342as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16343while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16344real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16345delay.
16346
16347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163488.1. Log levels
16349---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016350
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016351TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016352source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016353HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16354in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16355track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16356syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16357about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016358
16359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163608.2. Log formats
16361----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016362
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016363HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016364and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16365slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16366options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016367
16368 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16369 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16370 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16371 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16372 extents.
16373
16374 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16375 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16376 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16377 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16378 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16379
16380 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16381 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16382 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16383 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16384 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16385
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016386 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16387 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16388 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16389 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16390
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016391 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16392
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016393Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16394specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16395field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16396servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16397always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16398identifier.
16399
16400Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16401 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16402 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16403 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16404 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16405
16406
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164078.2.1. Default log format
16408-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016409
16410This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16411as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16412format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16413
16414 Example :
16415 listen www
16416 mode http
16417 log global
16418 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16419
16420 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16421 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16422 (www/HTTP)
16423
16424 Field Format Extract from the example above
16425 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16426 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16427 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16428 4 'to' to
16429 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16430 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16431
16432Detailed fields description :
16433 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16434 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16435 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16436 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16437 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16438 and processed the connection.
16439 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16440
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016441In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16442"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16443connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16444
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016445It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16446will eventually disappear.
16447
16448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164498.2.2. TCP log format
16450---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016451
16452The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16453is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16454information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16455counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16456emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16457environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16458the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16459sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016460specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16461not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16462fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16463marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016464
16465 Example :
16466 frontend fnt
16467 mode tcp
16468 option tcplog
16469 log global
16470 default_backend bck
16471
16472 backend bck
16473 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16474
16475 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16476 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16477 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16478
16479 Field Format Extract from the example above
16480 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16481 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16482 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16483 4 frontend_name fnt
16484 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16485 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16486 7 bytes_read* 212
16487 8 termination_state --
16488 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16489 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16490
16491Detailed fields description :
16492 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016493 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16494 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16495 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016496 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016497 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016498 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016499
16500 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016501 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16502 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16503 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016504
16505 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16506 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16507 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016508 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16509 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16510 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16511 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016512
16513 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16514 and processed the connection.
16515
16516 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16517 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16518 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16519 applications.
16520
16521 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16522 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16523 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16524 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16525 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16526
16527 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16528 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16529 See "Timers" below for more details.
16530
16531 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16532 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16533 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16534 "Timers" below for more details.
16535
16536 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016537 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016538 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16539 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16540 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16541 details.
16542
16543 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16544 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16545 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16546 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16547 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16548
16549 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16550 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16551 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16552 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16553 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16554 for more details.
16555
16556 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016557 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016558 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16559 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16560 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016561 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016562
16563 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16564 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16565 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16566 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16567 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16568 caused by a denial of service attack.
16569
16570 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16571 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16572 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16573 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16574 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16575 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16576 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16577 denial of service attack.
16578
16579 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16580 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16581 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16582 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16583 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16584 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16585 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16586 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16587 be processed than on other servers.
16588
16589 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16590 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16591 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16592 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16593 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16594 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16595 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16596 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16597 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16598 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16599 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16600 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16601 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16602
16603 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16604 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16605 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16606 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16607 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16608 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016609 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016610 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16611
16612 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16613 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16614 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16615 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16616 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16617 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016618 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016619 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16620 occurs.
16621
16622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166238.2.3. HTTP log format
16624----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016625
16626The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16627is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16628the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16629are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16630emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16631generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16632"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16633which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016634frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16635is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016636
16637Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16638slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16639with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16640
16641 Example :
16642 frontend http-in
16643 mode http
16644 option httplog
16645 log global
16646 default_backend bck
16647
16648 backend static
16649 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16650
16651 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16652 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16653 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016654 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016655
16656 Field Format Extract from the example above
16657 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16658 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016659 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016660 4 frontend_name http-in
16661 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016662 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016663 7 status_code 200
16664 8 bytes_read* 2750
16665 9 captured_request_cookie -
16666 10 captured_response_cookie -
16667 11 termination_state ----
16668 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16669 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16670 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16671 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16672 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016673
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016674Detailed fields description :
16675 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016676 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16677 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16678 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016679 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016680 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016681 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016682
16683 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016684 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16685 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16686 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016687
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016688 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16689 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016690
16691 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16692 and processed the connection.
16693
16694 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16695 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16696 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16697
16698 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16699 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16700 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16701 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16702 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16703 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16704
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016705 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16706 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16707 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016708 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016709 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16710 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016711 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16712 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016713
16714 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16715 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016716 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016717
16718 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16719 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016720 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16721 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016722
16723 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16724 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16725 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16726 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16727 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016728 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16729 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016730
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016731 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16732 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16733 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16734 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16735 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16736 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16737 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016738 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016739
16740 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16741 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16742 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16743
16744 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16745 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016746 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016747 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16748 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16749 overflowing.
16750
16751 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16752 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16753 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16754 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16755 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16756 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16757 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16758 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16759
16760 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16761 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16762 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16763 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16764 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16765 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16766 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16767 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16768
16769 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16770 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16771 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16772 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16773 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16774 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16775 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16776
16777 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016778 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016779 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16780 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16781 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016782 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016783 system.
16784
16785 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16786 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16787 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16788 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16789 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16790 caused by a denial of service attack.
16791
16792 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16793 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16794 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16795 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16796 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16797 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16798 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16799 denial of service attack.
16800
16801 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16802 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16803 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16804 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16805 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16806 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16807 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16808 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16809 processed than on other servers.
16810
16811 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16812 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16813 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16814 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16815 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16816 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16817 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16818 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16819 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16820 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16821 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16822 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16823 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16824
16825 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16826 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16827 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16828 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16829 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16830 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016831 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016832 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16833
16834 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16835 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16836 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16837 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16838 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16839 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016840 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016841 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16842 occurs.
16843
16844 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16845 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16846 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16847 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16848 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16849 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16850 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16851 cookies" below for more details.
16852
16853 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16854 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16855 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16856 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16857 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16858 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16859 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16860 and cookies" below for more details.
16861
16862 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16863 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16864 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16865 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16866 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16867 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16868 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16869 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16870
16871
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168728.2.4. Custom log format
16873------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016874
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016875The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016876mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016877
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016878HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016879Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16880separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16881prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16882
16883Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16884variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016885("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016886
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016887If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016888as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016889less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16890the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16891
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016892Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016893In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016894in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016895
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016896Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16897'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16898https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16899such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16900
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016901Flags are :
16902 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016903 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016904 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16905 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016906
16907 Example:
16908
16909 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16910 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16911
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016912 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16913
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016914At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16915
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016916 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16917 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016918
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016919the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016920
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016921 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16922 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16923 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016924
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016925and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16926
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016927 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16928 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016929
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016930Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16931
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016932 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016933 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016934 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16935 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16936 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016937 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16938 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16939 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016940 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016941 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16942 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016943 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016944 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16945 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016946 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016947 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016948 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016949 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016950 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016951 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016952 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016953 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16954 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16955 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16956 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16957 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016958 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016959 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16960 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016961 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016962 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16963 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016964 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16965 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16966 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016967 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016968 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16969 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016970 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016971 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16972 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16973 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016974 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016975 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016976 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16977 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16978 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16979 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016980 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016981 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016982 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016983 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016984 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016985 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016986 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16987 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16988 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016989 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016990 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16991 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016992 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016993 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16994 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016995 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016996 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016997 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016998 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016999
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017000 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017001
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017002
170038.2.5. Error log format
17004-----------------------
17005
17006When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17007protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17008By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17009"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017010will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017011logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17012
17013The format looks like this :
17014
17015 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17016 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17017 Connection error during SSL handshake
17018
17019 Field Format Extract from the example above
17020 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17021 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17022 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17023 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17024 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17025
17026These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17027failures.
17028
17029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170308.3. Advanced logging options
17031-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017032
17033Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17034just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17035options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17036for more information about their usage.
17037
17038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170398.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17040------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017041
17042It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17043haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17044commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17045monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17046ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17047
17048 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17049 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17050 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17051 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17052
17053 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17054 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17055 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017056 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017057 such as other load-balancers.
17058
17059 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17060 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17061 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17062
17063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170648.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17065----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017066
17067The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17068what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17069or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017070"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017071just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17072log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17073after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17074is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17075with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17076with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17077
17078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170798.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17080------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017081
17082Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17083for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17084"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17085retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17086raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17087a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17088file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17089you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17090"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17091
17092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170938.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17094--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017095
17096Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17097multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17098them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17099"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17100logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17101error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17102and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17103too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17104useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17105alternative.
17106
17107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171088.4. Timing events
17109------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017110
17111Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17112reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17113the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17114frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017115mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17116addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17117
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017118Timings events in HTTP mode:
17119
17120 first request 2nd request
17121 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17122 t tr t tr ...
17123 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17124 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17125 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17126 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17127 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17128
17129Timings events in TCP mode:
17130
17131 TCP session
17132 |<----------------->|
17133 t t
17134 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17135 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17136 |<------ Tt ------->|
17137
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017138 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017139 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017140 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17141 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17142 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017143 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017144 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17145 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17146 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17147 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017148
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017149 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17150 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17151 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017152 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17153 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17154 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17155 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17156 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17157 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017158
17159 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17160 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17161 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17162 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17163 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17164 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17165 request typed by hand during a test.
17166
17167 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17168 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017169 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017170 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17171 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17172 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17173 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017174
17175 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17176 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17177 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17178 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17179 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17180
17181 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17182 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17183 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17184 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17185 connection never established.
17186
17187 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17188 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17189 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17190 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17191 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17192 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17193 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17194 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17195 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17196 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17197 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17198
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017199 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17200 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17201 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17202 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17203 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17204 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17205
17206 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17207
17208 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17209 "Ta" can never be negative.
17210
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017211 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17212 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017213 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17214 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017215 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017216
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017217 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017218
17219 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017220 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17221 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017222
17223These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17224protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17225that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017226due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17227"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17228that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017229
17230Most common cases :
17231
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017232 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17233 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17234 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17235 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17236 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17237 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17238 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17239 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17240 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17241 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17242 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017243 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017244
17245 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17246 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17247 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17248 of ms on remote networks.
17249
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017250 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17251 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17252 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017253
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017254 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17255 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17256 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17257 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17258 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17259 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17260 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17261 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17262 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017263
17264Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17265
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017266 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017267 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017268 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017269
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017270 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017271 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17272 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17273
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017274 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017275 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17276 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17277 flags.
17278
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017279 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17280 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017281 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17282 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17283 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17284 the client connection was maintained open.
17285
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017286 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017287 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017288 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017289 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17290
17291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172928.5. Session state at disconnection
17293-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017294
17295TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17296"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
172972-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17298each of which has a special meaning :
17299
17300 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17301 session to terminate :
17302
17303 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17304
17305 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17306 server explicitly refused it.
17307
17308 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17309 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17310 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17311 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017312 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017313
17314 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17315 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017316
17317 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17318 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17319 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17320 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17321 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17322
17323 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17324 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17325 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17326 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17327 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17328
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017329 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17330 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17331
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017332 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17333 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17334 backup connections when going up.
17335
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017336 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17337
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017338 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17339 send or receive data.
17340
17341 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17342 send or receive data.
17343
17344 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17345 with nothing left in the buffers.
17346
17347 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17348
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017349 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017350 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17351
17352 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17353 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17354 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17355 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17356 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17357
17358 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17359 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17360
17361 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17362 server (HTTP only).
17363
17364 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17365
17366 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17367 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17368 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17369
17370 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17371 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17372 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17373
17374 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17375
17376 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17377 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17378
17379 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17380 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17381 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17382
17383 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17384 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017385 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17386 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017387
17388 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17389 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17390 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17391 another server.
17392
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017393 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017394 server.
17395
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017396 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17397 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17398 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17399 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17400
17401 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17402 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17403 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17404 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17405
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017406 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17407 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17408 "use-server" rule).
17409
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017410 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17411
17412 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17413 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17414
17415 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17416
17417 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17418 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17419 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17420
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017421 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17422 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017423 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017424 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17425 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17426
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017427 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17428
17429 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17430 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17431
17432 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17433
17434 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17435
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017436The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17437was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017438helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17439starvation, attacks, etc...
17440
17441The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17442alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17443easier finding and understanding.
17444
17445 Flags Reason
17446
17447 -- Normal termination.
17448
17449 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17450 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17451 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17452 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17453
17454 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17455 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17456 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17457 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17458 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17459 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017460
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017461 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17462 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017463 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017464
17465 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17466 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17467 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17468
17469 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17470 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17471 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17472 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17473 the server takes too long to respond.
17474
17475 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17476 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17477 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17478 long a time to respond.
17479
17480 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17481 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17482 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17483 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017484 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17485 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017486
17487 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17488 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17489 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17490 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17491 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017492 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017493 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17494 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17495 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17496 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17497 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17498 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17499 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17500 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017501 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017502 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17503 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17504 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017505
17506 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17507 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017508 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17509 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17510 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17511 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017512
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017513 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17514 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017516 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017517 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17518 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017519 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017520 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17521 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17522
17523 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17524 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17525 503 or 504 here.
17526
17527 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17528 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17529 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17530 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17531 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17532
17533 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17534 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017535 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017536 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17537 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17538
17539 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17540 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17541 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17542 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17543 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17544 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17545 between haproxy and the server.
17546
17547 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17548 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17549 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17550 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17551 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17552 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17553 solution is to fix the application.
17554
17555 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17556 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17557 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17558 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17559 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17560 external attacks.
17561
17562 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17563 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017564 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017565 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17566 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17567
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017568 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17569 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17570 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017571 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017572 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017573
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017574 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17575 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17576 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17577 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017578 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17579 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17580 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17581 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17582 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017583
17584 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17585 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17586 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17587 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17588
17589 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17590 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17591 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17592 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17593
17594 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17595 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17596 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17597 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17598
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017599The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17600persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17601important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17602re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17603
17604 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17605
17606 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17607 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17608 set on a GET request.
17609
17610 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17611 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017612 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017613 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17614
17615 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17616 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17617 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17618
17619 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17620 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17621 already got a cookie.
17622
17623 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17624 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17625 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17626 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17627 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17628
17629 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17630 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17631 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17632
17633 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17634 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17635 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17636
17637 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17638 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17639
17640 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17641 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17642 then advertised in the response.
17643
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176458.6. Non-printable characters
17646-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017647
17648In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17649consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17650converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17651prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17652being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17653escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17654is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17655'}' when logging headers.
17656
17657Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17658issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17659containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17660
17661Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17662the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17663performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17664
17665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176668.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17667---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017668
17669Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17670achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017671section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017672cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17673the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17674the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017675locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017676not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17677user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17678a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17679wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17680
17681 Examples :
17682 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17683 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17684
17685 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17686 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17687
17688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17690---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017691
17692Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17693proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17694the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17695server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17696
17697Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17698response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017699section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017700
17701It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017702time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17703appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017704are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17705and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17706follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17707request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17708in the logs.
17709
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017710As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17711frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17712an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17713
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017714 Example :
17715 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17716 listen proxy-out
17717 mode http
17718 option httplog
17719 option logasap
17720 log global
17721 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17722
17723 # log the name of the virtual server
17724 capture request header Host len 20
17725
17726 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17727 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17728
17729 # log the beginning of the referrer
17730 capture request header Referer len 20
17731
17732 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17733 capture response header Server len 20
17734
17735 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17736 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17737
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017738 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017739 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17740
17741 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17742 capture response header Via len 20
17743
17744 # log the URL location during a redirection
17745 capture response header Location len 20
17746
17747 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17748 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17749 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17750 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17751 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17752
17753 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17754 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17755 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17756 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017757 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017758
17759 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17760 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17761 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17762 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17763 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017764 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017765
17766
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177678.9. Examples of logs
17768---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017769
17770These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17771them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17772reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17773
17774 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17775 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17776 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17777
17778 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17779 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17780
17781 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17782 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17783 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17784
17785 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17786 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17787
17788 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17789 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17790 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17791
17792 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017793 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017794 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17795 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17796
17797 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17798 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17799 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17800
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017801 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
17802 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
17803 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
17804 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
17805 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
17806 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017807
17808 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017809 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017810
17811 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17812 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17813 Nothing was sent to any server.
17814
17815 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17816 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17817
17818 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17819 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017820 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017821 send a 408 return code to the client.
17822
17823 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17824 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17825
17826 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17827 5 seconds ("c----").
17828
17829 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17830 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017831 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017832
17833 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017834 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017835 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17836 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17837 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17838 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17839 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017840
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017841
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178429. Supported filters
17843--------------------
17844
17845Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17846accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17847unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17848
17849See also : "filter"
17850
178519.1. Trace
17852----------
17853
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017854filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017855
17856 Arguments:
17857 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17858 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17859
17860 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17861 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17862 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17863 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17864
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017865 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017866 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17867 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17868 amount of the parsed data.
17869
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017870 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017871
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017872This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17873callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17874information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17875filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17876
17877Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17878tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17879a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17880
17881
178829.2. HTTP compression
17883---------------------
17884
17885filter compression
17886
17887The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17888keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017889when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
17890fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
17891done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
17892explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
17893filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
17894listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17895order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017896
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017897See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
17898 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017899
17900
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200179019.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17902--------------------------------------------
17903
17904filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17905
17906 Arguments :
17907
17908 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17909 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17910 parsed.
17911
17912 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17913 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17914 part must be placed in its own scope.
17915
17916The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17917external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017918streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017919exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17920also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17921
17922SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17923the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17924
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017925For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017926"doc/SPOE.txt".
17927
17928Important note:
17929 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17930 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17931
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179329.4. Cache
17933----------
17934
17935filter cache <name>
17936
17937 Arguments :
17938
17939 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17940
17941The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17942"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017943cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017944other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
17945case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
17946is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17947filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017948listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17949order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017950
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020017951See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
17952 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
17953
17954
179559.5. Fcgi-app
17956-------------
17957
17958filter fcg-app <name>
17959
17960 Arguments :
17961
17962 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
17963
17964The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
17965request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
17966reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
17967used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
17968implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
17969used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
17970fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
17971used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17972order.
17973
17974See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
17975 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
17976
17977
1797810. FastCGI applications
17979-------------------------
17980
17981HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
17982feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
17983the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
17984FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
17985servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
17986FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
17987backend.
17988
17989HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
17990application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
17991connection.
17992
1799310.1. Setup
17994-----------
17995
1799610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
17997--------------------------
17998
17999fcgi-app <name>
18000 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18001 document root must be defined.
18002
18003acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18004 Declare or complete an access list.
18005
18006 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18007 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18008 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18009 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18010 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18011
18012docroot <path>
18013 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18014 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18015 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18016
18017index <script-name>
18018 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18019 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18020 is an optional setting.
18021
18022 Example :
18023 index index.php
18024
18025log-stderr global
18026log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18027 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18028 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18029
18030 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18031 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18032
18033pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18034 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18035 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18036 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18037
18038 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18039 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18040 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18041 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18042
18043 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18044 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18045
18046path-info <regex>
18047 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18048 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18049 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18050 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18051 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18052
18053 Example :
18054 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18055
18056option get-values
18057no option get-values
18058 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18059
18060 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18061 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18062
18063 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18064 application will accept.
18065
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018066 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18067 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018068
18069 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18070 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18071 option is disabled.
18072
18073 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18074 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18075 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18076 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18077 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18078 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18079
18080option keep-conn
18081no option keep-conn
18082 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18083 sending a response.
18084
18085 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18086 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18087
18088option max-reqs <reqs>
18089 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18090 accept.
18091
18092 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18093 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18094 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18095 to 1.
18096
18097option mpxs-conns
18098no option mpxs-conns
18099 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18100
18101 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18102 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18103
18104set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18105 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18106 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18107 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18108 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18109
18110 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18111 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18112 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18113
18114 Example :
18115 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18116 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18117
18118 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18119
18120
1812110.1.2. Proxy section
18122---------------------
18123
18124use-fcgi-app <name>
18125 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18126
18127 Arguments :
18128 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18129
18130 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18131 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18132 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18133 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18134 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18135
18136 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18137 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18138 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18139 application are evaluated.
18140
18141
1814210.1.3. Example
18143---------------
18144
18145 frontend front-http
18146 mode http
18147 bind *:80
18148 bind *:
18149
18150 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18151 default_backend back-static
18152
18153 backend back-static
18154 mode http
18155 server www A.B.C.D:80
18156
18157 backend back-dynamic
18158 mode http
18159 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18160 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18161
18162 fcgi-app php-fpm
18163 log-stderr global
18164 option keep-conn
18165
18166 docroot /var/www/my-app
18167 index index.php
18168 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18169
18170
1817110.2. Default parameters
18172------------------------
18173
18174A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18175the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18176scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18177applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18178
18179 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18180 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18181 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18182 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18183 | | |
18184 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18185 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18186 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18187 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18188 | | application. |
18189 | | |
18190 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18191 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18192 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18193 | | |
18194 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18195 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18196 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18197 | | the application's configuration. |
18198 | | |
18199 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18200 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18201 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18202 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18203 | | |
18204 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18205 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18206 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18207 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18208 | | be defined. |
18209 | | |
18210 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18211 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18212 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18213 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18214 | | is not set too. |
18215 | | |
18216 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18217 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18218 | | set. |
18219 | | |
18220 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18221 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18222 | | the request. |
18223 | | |
18224 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18225 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18226 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18227 | | |
18228 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18229 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18230 | | script to process the request. |
18231 | | |
18232 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18233 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18234 | | |
18235 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18236 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18237 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18238 | | |
18239 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18240 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18241 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18242 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18243 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18244 | | |
18245 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18246 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18247 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18248 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18249 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18250 | | side. |
18251 | | |
18252 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18253 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18254 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18255 | | connected to. |
18256 | | |
18257 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18258 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18259 | | |
18260 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18261 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18262 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18263 | | |
18264 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18265
18266
1826710.3. Limitations
18268------------------
18269
18270The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18271way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18272during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18273establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18274application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18275or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18276message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18277these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18278and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18279
18280Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18281request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18282requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18283
18284About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18285into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18286fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18287"http-request" ones.
18288
18289Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18290FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18291processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18292must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18293here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018294
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018295/*
18296 * Local variables:
18297 * fill-column: 79
18298 * End:
18299 */